1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6 *
7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2024 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27
28 /**
29 * DOC: Introduction
30 *
31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37 *
38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39 * use restrictions.
40 */
41
42
43 /**
44 * DOC: Device registration
45 *
46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48 * described below.
49 *
50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55 * the wireless part of the interface. Normally this struct is embedded in the
56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59 *
60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63 */
64
65 struct wiphy;
66
67 /*
68 * wireless hardware capability structures
69 */
70
71 /**
72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73 *
74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75 *
76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78 * sending probe requests or beaconing.
79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this
80 * channel.
81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
83 * is not permitted.
84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
85 * is not permitted.
86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
88 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
91 * restrictions.
92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
93 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
94 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
95 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
96 * restrictions.
97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100 * on this channel.
101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
102 * on this channel.
103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105 * on this channel.
106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107 * on this channel.
108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109 * on this channel.
110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111 * on this channel.
112 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
113 * on this channel.
114 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band,
115 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this
116 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
117 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
118 * restrictions.
119 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel.
120 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT: See %NL80211_RRF_DFS_CONCURRENT
121 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT: Client connection with VLP AP
122 * not permitted using this channel
123 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT: Client connection with AFC AP
124 * not permitted using this channel
125 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR: This channel can be used for monitor
126 * mode even in the presence of other (regulatory) restrictions,
127 * even if it is otherwise disabled.
128 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP: Allow using this channel for AP operation
129 * with very low power (VLP), even if otherwise set to NO_IR.
130 */
131 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
132 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = BIT(0),
133 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = BIT(1),
134 IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = BIT(2),
135 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = BIT(3),
136 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = BIT(4),
137 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = BIT(5),
138 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = BIT(6),
139 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = BIT(7),
140 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = BIT(8),
141 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = BIT(9),
142 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = BIT(10),
143 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = BIT(11),
144 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = BIT(12),
145 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = BIT(13),
146 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = BIT(14),
147 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = BIT(15),
148 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = BIT(16),
149 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = BIT(17),
150 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = BIT(18),
151 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = BIT(19),
152 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = BIT(20),
153 IEEE80211_CHAN_DFS_CONCURRENT = BIT(21),
154 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_VLP_CLIENT = BIT(22),
155 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_6GHZ_AFC_CLIENT = BIT(23),
156 IEEE80211_CHAN_CAN_MONITOR = BIT(24),
157 IEEE80211_CHAN_ALLOW_6GHZ_VLP_AP = BIT(25),
158 };
159
160 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
161 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
162
163 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000
164 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000)
165
166 /**
167 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
168 *
169 * This structure describes a single channel for use
170 * with cfg80211.
171 *
172 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
173 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
174 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
175 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
176 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
177 * code to support devices with additional restrictions
178 * @band: band this channel belongs to.
179 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
180 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
181 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
182 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
183 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
184 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
185 * @orig_mag: internal use
186 * @orig_mpwr: internal use
187 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
188 * on this channel.
189 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
190 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
191 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm)
192 */
193 struct ieee80211_channel {
194 enum nl80211_band band;
195 u32 center_freq;
196 u16 freq_offset;
197 u16 hw_value;
198 u32 flags;
199 int max_antenna_gain;
200 int max_power;
201 int max_reg_power;
202 bool beacon_found;
203 u32 orig_flags;
204 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
205 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
206 unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
207 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
208 s8 psd;
209 };
210
211 /**
212 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
213 *
214 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
215 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
216 * different bands/PHY modes.
217 *
218 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
219 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
220 * with CCK rates.
221 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
222 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
223 * core code when registering the wiphy.
224 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
225 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
226 * core code when registering the wiphy.
227 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
228 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
229 * core code when registering the wiphy.
230 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
231 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
232 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
233 */
234 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
235 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(0),
236 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = BIT(1),
237 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = BIT(2),
238 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = BIT(3),
239 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = BIT(4),
240 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = BIT(5),
241 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = BIT(6),
242 };
243
244 /**
245 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
246 *
247 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
248 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
249 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
250 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
251 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
252 */
253 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
254 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
255 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
256 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
257 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
258 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
259 };
260
261 /**
262 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
263 *
264 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
265 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
266 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
267 */
268 enum ieee80211_privacy {
269 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
270 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
271 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
272 };
273
274 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \
275 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
276
277 /**
278 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
279 *
280 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
281 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
282 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
283 * passed around.
284 *
285 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags
286 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
287 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
288 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
289 * short preamble is used
290 */
291 struct ieee80211_rate {
292 u32 flags;
293 u16 bitrate;
294 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
295 };
296
297 /**
298 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
299 *
300 * @enable: is the feature enabled.
301 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
302 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
303 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
304 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
305 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
306 * members of the SRG
307 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
308 * used by members of the SRG
309 */
310 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
311 bool enable;
312 u8 sr_ctrl;
313 u8 non_srg_max_offset;
314 u8 min_offset;
315 u8 max_offset;
316 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
317 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
318 };
319
320 /**
321 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
322 *
323 * @color: the current color.
324 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
325 * @partial: define the AID equation.
326 */
327 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
328 u8 color;
329 bool enabled;
330 bool partial;
331 };
332
333 /**
334 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
335 *
336 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
337 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
338 *
339 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
340 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
341 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
342 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
343 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
344 */
345 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
346 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
347 bool ht_supported;
348 u8 ampdu_factor;
349 u8 ampdu_density;
350 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
351 };
352
353 /**
354 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
355 *
356 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
357 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
358 *
359 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
360 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
361 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
362 */
363 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
364 bool vht_supported;
365 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
366 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
367 };
368
369 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25
370
371 /**
372 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
373 *
374 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
375 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
376 *
377 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
378 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
379 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
380 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
381 */
382 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
383 bool has_he;
384 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
385 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
386 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
387 };
388
389 /**
390 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS
391 *
392 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS
393 * and NSS Set field"
394 *
395 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA.
396 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz
397 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz
398 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz
399 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz
400 */
401 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp {
402 union {
403 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz;
404 struct {
405 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80;
406 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160;
407 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320;
408 } __packed bw;
409 } __packed;
410 } __packed;
411
412 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32
413
414 /**
415 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities
416 *
417 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
418 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA.
419 *
420 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid.
421 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element.
422 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
423 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
424 */
425 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap {
426 bool has_eht;
427 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem;
428 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp;
429 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
430 };
431
432 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */
433 #ifdef __CHECKER__
434 /*
435 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed
436 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot
437 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be
438 * noisy when the pointer is used directly.
439 */
440 # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data)))
441 #else
442 # define __iftd
443 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */
444
445 /**
446 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
447 *
448 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
449 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the
450 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
451 *
452 * @types_mask: interface types mask
453 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
454 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
455 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
456 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities
457 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
458 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
459 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
460 */
461 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
462 u16 types_mask;
463 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
464 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
465 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
466 struct {
467 const u8 *data;
468 unsigned int len;
469 } vendor_elems;
470 };
471
472 /**
473 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
474 *
475 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
476 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
477 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
478 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
479 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
480 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
481 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
482 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
483 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
484 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
485 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
486 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
487 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
488 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
489 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
490 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
491 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
492 */
493 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
494 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4,
495 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5,
496 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6,
497 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7,
498 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8,
499 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9,
500 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10,
501 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11,
502 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12,
503 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13,
504 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14,
505 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15,
506 };
507
508 /**
509 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
510 *
511 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
512 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
513 *
514 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
515 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
516 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
517 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
518 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
519 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
520 */
521 struct ieee80211_edmg {
522 u8 channels;
523 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
524 };
525
526 /**
527 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
528 *
529 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
530 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
531 *
532 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA
533 * @cap: S1G capabilities information
534 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
535 */
536 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
537 bool s1g;
538 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
539 u8 nss_mcs[5];
540 };
541
542 /**
543 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
544 *
545 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
546 * is able to operate in.
547 *
548 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
549 * in this band.
550 * @band: the band this structure represents
551 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
552 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
553 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
554 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
555 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
556 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
557 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
558 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
559 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
560 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
561 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
562 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in
563 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
564 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
565 * iftype_data).
566 */
567 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
568 struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
569 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
570 enum nl80211_band band;
571 int n_channels;
572 int n_bitrates;
573 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
574 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
575 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
576 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
577 u16 n_iftype_data;
578 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data;
579 };
580
581 /**
582 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
583 * @sband: the sband to initialize
584 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer
585 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array
586 *
587 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot
588 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer
589 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used.
590 */
591 static inline void
_ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * iftd,u16 n_iftd)592 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
593 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd,
594 u16 n_iftd)
595 {
596 sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd;
597 sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd;
598 }
599
600 /**
601 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array
602 * @sband: the sband to initialize
603 * @iftd: the iftype data array
604 */
605 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \
606 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd))
607
608 /**
609 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries
610 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate
611 * @i: iterator counter
612 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set
613 */
614 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \
615 for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \
616 i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \
617 i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i])
618
619 /**
620 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
621 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
622 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
623 *
624 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
625 */
626 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)627 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
628 u8 iftype)
629 {
630 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data;
631 int i;
632
633 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
634 return NULL;
635
636 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN)
637 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP;
638
639 for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) {
640 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
641 return data;
642 }
643
644 return NULL;
645 }
646
647 /**
648 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
649 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
650 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
651 *
652 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
653 */
654 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,u8 iftype)655 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
656 u8 iftype)
657 {
658 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
659 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
660
661 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
662 return &data->he_cap;
663
664 return NULL;
665 }
666
667 /**
668 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
669 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
670 * @iftype: the iftype to search for
671 *
672 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
673 */
674 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)675 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
676 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
677 {
678 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
679 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
680
681 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
682 return 0;
683
684 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
685 }
686
687 /**
688 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype
689 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
690 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
691 *
692 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found
693 */
694 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)695 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
696 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
697 {
698 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
699 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
700
701 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht)
702 return &data->eht_cap;
703
704 return NULL;
705 }
706
707 /**
708 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
709 *
710 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
711 *
712 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
713 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
714 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
715 *
716 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
717 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
718 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
719 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
720 * without affecting other devices.
721 *
722 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
723 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
724 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
725 */
726 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
727 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
728 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy * wiphy)729 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
730 {
731 }
732 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
733
734
735 /*
736 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
737 */
738
739 /**
740 * DOC: Actions and configuration
741 *
742 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
743 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
744 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
745 * operations use are described separately.
746 *
747 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
748 * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
749 *
750 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
751 * in a separate chapter.
752 */
753
754 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
755 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
756
757 /**
758 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
759 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
760 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
761 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
762 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
763 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
764 * determine the address as needed.
765 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
766 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating
767 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC.
768 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
769 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
770 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
771 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
772 */
773 struct vif_params {
774 u32 flags;
775 int use_4addr;
776 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
777 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
778 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
779 };
780
781 /**
782 * struct key_params - key information
783 *
784 * Information about a key
785 *
786 * @key: key material
787 * @key_len: length of key material
788 * @cipher: cipher suite selector
789 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
790 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
791 * length given by @seq_len.
792 * @seq_len: length of @seq.
793 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
794 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
795 */
796 struct key_params {
797 const u8 *key;
798 const u8 *seq;
799 int key_len;
800 int seq_len;
801 u16 vlan_id;
802 u32 cipher;
803 enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
804 };
805
806 /**
807 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
808 * @chan: the (control) channel
809 * @width: channel width
810 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
811 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
812 * (only with 80+80 MHz)
813 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
814 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
815 * chan will define the primary channel and all other
816 * parameters are ignored.
817 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
818 * @punctured: mask of the punctured 20 MHz subchannels, with
819 * bits turned on being disabled (punctured); numbered
820 * from lower to higher frequency (like in the spec)
821 */
822 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
823 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
824 enum nl80211_chan_width width;
825 u32 center_freq1;
826 u32 center_freq2;
827 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
828 u16 freq1_offset;
829 u16 punctured;
830 };
831
832 /*
833 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
834 */
835 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
836 struct {
837 u32 legacy;
838 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
839 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
840 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
841 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
842 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
843 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
844 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
845 };
846
847
848 /**
849 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
850 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
851 * of the peer.
852 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
853 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
854 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
855 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
856 * @retry_long: retry count value
857 * @retry_short: retry count value
858 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
859 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
860 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
861 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
862 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
863 */
864 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
865 bool config_override;
866 u8 tids;
867 u64 mask;
868 enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
869 u8 retry_long, retry_short;
870 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
871 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
872 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
873 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
874 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
875 };
876
877 /**
878 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
879 * @peer: Station's MAC address
880 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
881 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
882 */
883 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
884 const u8 *peer;
885 u32 n_tid_conf;
886 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf);
887 };
888
889 /**
890 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data
891 * @macaddr: STA MAC address
892 * @kek: FILS KEK
893 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length
894 * @snonce: STA Nonce
895 * @anonce: AP Nonce
896 */
897 struct cfg80211_fils_aad {
898 const u8 *macaddr;
899 const u8 *kek;
900 u8 kek_len;
901 const u8 *snonce;
902 const u8 *anonce;
903 };
904
905 /**
906 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping
907 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all
908 * addresses.
909 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
910 * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address.
911 */
912 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp {
913 const u8 *macaddr;
914 bool enable;
915 };
916
917 /**
918 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
919 * @chandef: the channel definition
920 *
921 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
922 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
923 */
924 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)925 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
926 {
927 switch (chandef->width) {
928 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
929 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
930 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
931 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
932 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
933 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
934 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
935 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
936 default:
937 WARN_ON(1);
938 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
939 }
940 }
941
942 /**
943 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
944 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
945 * @channel: the control channel
946 * @chantype: the channel type
947 *
948 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
949 */
950 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
951 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
952 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
953
954 /**
955 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
956 * @chandef1: first channel definition
957 * @chandef2: second channel definition
958 *
959 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
960 * identical, %false otherwise.
961 */
962 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef1,const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef2)963 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
964 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
965 {
966 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
967 chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
968 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
969 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
970 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2 &&
971 chandef1->punctured == chandef2->punctured);
972 }
973
974 /**
975 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
976 *
977 * @chandef: the channel definition
978 *
979 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
980 */
981 static inline bool
cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)982 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
983 {
984 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
985 }
986
987 /**
988 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
989 * @chandef1: first channel definition
990 * @chandef2: second channel definition
991 *
992 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
993 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
994 */
995 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
996 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
997 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
998
999 /**
1000 * nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz - get the channel width in MHz
1001 * @chan_width: the channel width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1002 *
1003 * Return: channel width in MHz if the chan_width from &enum nl80211_chan_width
1004 * is valid. -1 otherwise.
1005 */
1006 int nl80211_chan_width_to_mhz(enum nl80211_chan_width chan_width);
1007
1008 /**
1009 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
1010 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1011 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
1012 */
1013 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1014
1015 /**
1016 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
1017 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1018 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1019 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
1020 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
1021 */
1022 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1023 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1024 u32 prohibited_flags);
1025
1026 /**
1027 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
1028 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1029 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1030 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
1031 * Returns:
1032 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
1033 */
1034 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1035 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1036 enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
1037
1038 /**
1039 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we
1040 * can/need start CAC on such channel
1041 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1042 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1043 *
1044 * Return: true if all channels available and at least
1045 * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE)
1046 */
1047 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1048 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1049
1050 /**
1051 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given
1052 * channel definition
1053 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
1054 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1055 *
1056 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition
1057 */
1058 unsigned int
1059 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1060 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1061
1062 /**
1063 * cfg80211_chandef_primary - calculate primary 40/80/160 MHz freq
1064 * @chandef: chandef to calculate for
1065 * @primary_chan_width: primary channel width to calculate center for
1066 * @punctured: punctured sub-channel bitmap, will be recalculated
1067 * according to the new bandwidth, can be %NULL
1068 *
1069 * Returns: the primary 40/80/160 MHz channel center frequency, or -1
1070 * for errors, updating the punctured bitmap
1071 */
1072 int cfg80211_chandef_primary(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
1073 enum nl80211_chan_width primary_chan_width,
1074 u16 *punctured);
1075
1076 /**
1077 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition.
1078 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition
1079 * @chandef: the channel definition to check
1080 *
1081 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error
1082 **/
1083 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
1084
1085 /**
1086 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width
1087 * @width: the channel width of the channel
1088 *
1089 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
1090 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
1091 *
1092 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width
1093 */
1094 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)1095 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
1096 {
1097 switch (width) {
1098 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1099 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
1100 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1101 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
1102 default:
1103 break;
1104 }
1105 return 0;
1106 }
1107
1108 /**
1109 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
1110 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1111 *
1112 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags().
1113 *
1114 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
1115 */
1116 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1117 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1118 {
1119 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width);
1120 }
1121
1122 /**
1123 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
1124 *
1125 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
1126 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
1127 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
1128 *
1129 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
1130 *
1131 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
1132 */
1133 static inline int
ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)1134 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
1135 {
1136 switch (chandef->width) {
1137 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
1138 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
1139 chandef->chan->max_power);
1140 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
1141 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
1142 chandef->chan->max_power);
1143 default:
1144 break;
1145 }
1146 return chandef->chan->max_power;
1147 }
1148
1149 /**
1150 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
1151 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
1152 * @band_mask: which bands to check on
1153 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
1154 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
1155 *
1156 * Return: %true if usable channels found, %false otherwise
1157 */
1158 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1159 unsigned long band_mask,
1160 u32 prohibited_flags);
1161
1162 /**
1163 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
1164 *
1165 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
1166 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
1167 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
1168 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
1169 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
1170 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
1171 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
1172 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
1173 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
1174 *
1175 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
1176 * it has filled in during the get_survey().
1177 */
1178 enum survey_info_flags {
1179 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0),
1180 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1),
1181 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2),
1182 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3),
1183 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4),
1184 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5),
1185 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6),
1186 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7),
1187 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8),
1188 };
1189
1190 /**
1191 * struct survey_info - channel survey response
1192 *
1193 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
1194 * record to report global statistics
1195 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
1196 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
1197 * optional
1198 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
1199 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
1200 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
1201 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
1202 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
1203 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
1204 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
1205 *
1206 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
1207 *
1208 * This structure can later be expanded with things like
1209 * channel duty cycle etc.
1210 */
1211 struct survey_info {
1212 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
1213 u64 time;
1214 u64 time_busy;
1215 u64 time_ext_busy;
1216 u64 time_rx;
1217 u64 time_tx;
1218 u64 time_scan;
1219 u64 time_bss_rx;
1220 u32 filled;
1221 s8 noise;
1222 };
1223
1224 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10
1225
1226 /**
1227 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
1228 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
1229 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
1230 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
1231 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
1232 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
1233 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
1234 * @akm_suites: AKM suites
1235 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
1236 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
1237 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
1238 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
1239 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
1240 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports
1241 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
1242 * protocol frames.
1243 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
1244 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
1245 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
1246 * port for mac80211
1247 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1248 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1249 * offload)
1250 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1251 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1252 *
1253 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1254 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1255 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1256 * such a scenario.
1257 *
1258 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1259 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1260 *
1261 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1262 * Allow hash-to-element only
1263 *
1264 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1265 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1266 */
1267 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1268 u32 wpa_versions;
1269 u32 cipher_group;
1270 int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1271 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1272 int n_akm_suites;
1273 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES];
1274 bool control_port;
1275 __be16 control_port_ethertype;
1276 bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1277 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1278 bool control_port_no_preauth;
1279 const u8 *psk;
1280 const u8 *sae_pwd;
1281 u8 sae_pwd_len;
1282 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1283 };
1284
1285 /**
1286 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid
1287 *
1288 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set
1289 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group.
1290 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode.
1291 */
1292 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config {
1293 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev;
1294 u8 index;
1295 bool ema;
1296 };
1297
1298 /**
1299 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements
1300 *
1301 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1302 *
1303 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1304 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements.
1305 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1306 */
1307 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems {
1308 u8 cnt;
1309 struct {
1310 const u8 *data;
1311 size_t len;
1312 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1313 };
1314
1315 /**
1316 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements
1317 *
1318 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems.
1319 *
1320 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames.
1321 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements.
1322 * @elem.len: Length of data.
1323 */
1324 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems {
1325 u8 cnt;
1326 struct {
1327 const u8 *data;
1328 size_t len;
1329 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt);
1330 };
1331
1332 /**
1333 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1334 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon
1335 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1336 * or %NULL if not changed
1337 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1338 * or %NULL if not changed
1339 * @head_len: length of @head
1340 * @tail_len: length of @tail
1341 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1342 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1343 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1344 * frames or %NULL
1345 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1346 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1347 * Response frames or %NULL
1348 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1349 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1350 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1351 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements
1352 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements
1353 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1354 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1355 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1356 * (measurement type 8)
1357 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1358 * Token (measurement type 11)
1359 * @lci_len: LCI data length
1360 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1361 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1362 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color
1363 * attribute is present in beacon data or not.
1364 */
1365 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1366 unsigned int link_id;
1367
1368 const u8 *head, *tail;
1369 const u8 *beacon_ies;
1370 const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1371 const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1372 const u8 *probe_resp;
1373 const u8 *lci;
1374 const u8 *civicloc;
1375 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies;
1376 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies;
1377 s8 ftm_responder;
1378
1379 size_t head_len, tail_len;
1380 size_t beacon_ies_len;
1381 size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1382 size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1383 size_t probe_resp_len;
1384 size_t lci_len;
1385 size_t civicloc_len;
1386 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1387 bool he_bss_color_valid;
1388 };
1389
1390 struct mac_address {
1391 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1392 };
1393
1394 /**
1395 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1396 *
1397 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1398 * entry specified by mac_addr
1399 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1400 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1401 */
1402 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1403 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1404 int n_acl_entries;
1405
1406 /* Keep it last */
1407 struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries);
1408 };
1409
1410 /**
1411 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1412 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1413 *
1414 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1415 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1416 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1417 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1418 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1419 * frame headers.
1420 */
1421 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1422 bool update;
1423 u32 min_interval;
1424 u32 max_interval;
1425 size_t tmpl_len;
1426 const u8 *tmpl;
1427 };
1428
1429 /**
1430 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1431 * response parameters in 6GHz.
1432 *
1433 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated.
1434 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1435 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1436 * scanning
1437 * @tmpl_len: Template length
1438 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1439 */
1440 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1441 bool update;
1442 u32 interval;
1443 size_t tmpl_len;
1444 const u8 *tmpl;
1445 };
1446
1447 /**
1448 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1449 *
1450 * Used to configure an AP interface.
1451 *
1452 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1453 * @beacon: beacon data
1454 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1455 * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1456 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1457 * user space)
1458 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1459 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1460 * @crypto: crypto settings
1461 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1462 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1463 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1464 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1465 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1466 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1467 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1468 * MAC address based access control
1469 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1470 * networks.
1471 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1472 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1473 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1474 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1475 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1476 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled)
1477 * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1478 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1479 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1480 * @he_required: stations must support HE
1481 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1482 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags
1483 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1484 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1485 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1486 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1487 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid
1488 */
1489 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1490 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1491
1492 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1493
1494 int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1495 const u8 *ssid;
1496 size_t ssid_len;
1497 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1498 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1499 bool privacy;
1500 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1501 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1502 int inactivity_timeout;
1503 u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1504 bool p2p_opp_ps;
1505 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1506 bool pbss;
1507 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1508
1509 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1510 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1511 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1512 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1513 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap;
1514 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper;
1515 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1516 bool twt_responder;
1517 u32 flags;
1518 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1519 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1520 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1521 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config;
1522 };
1523
1524
1525 /**
1526 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update
1527 *
1528 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP.
1529 *
1530 * @beacon: beacon data
1531 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1532 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1533 */
1534 struct cfg80211_ap_update {
1535 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1536 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1537 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1538 };
1539
1540 /**
1541 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1542 *
1543 * Used for channel switch
1544 *
1545 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1546 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1547 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1548 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1549 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1550 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1551 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1552 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1553 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1554 * @count: number of beacons until switch
1555 * @link_id: defines the link on which channel switch is expected during
1556 * MLO. 0 in case of non-MLO.
1557 */
1558 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1559 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1560 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1561 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1562 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1563 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1564 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1565 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1566 bool radar_required;
1567 bool block_tx;
1568 u8 count;
1569 u8 link_id;
1570 };
1571
1572 /**
1573 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings
1574 *
1575 * Used for bss color change
1576 *
1577 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown
1578 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1579 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1580 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change
1581 * @count: number of beacons until the color change
1582 * @color: the color used after the change
1583 * @link_id: defines the link on which color change is expected during MLO.
1584 * 0 in case of non-MLO.
1585 */
1586 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings {
1587 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change;
1588 u16 counter_offset_beacon;
1589 u16 counter_offset_presp;
1590 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next;
1591 u8 count;
1592 u8 color;
1593 u8 link_id;
1594 };
1595
1596 /**
1597 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1598 *
1599 * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1600 *
1601 * @radio_idx: wiphy radio index or -1 for global
1602 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1603 * to use for verification
1604 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1605 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1606 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1607 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1608 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1609 * nl80211_iftype.
1610 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1611 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1612 * the verification
1613 */
1614 struct iface_combination_params {
1615 int radio_idx;
1616 int num_different_channels;
1617 u8 radar_detect;
1618 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1619 u32 new_beacon_int;
1620 };
1621
1622 /**
1623 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1624 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1625 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1626 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1627 *
1628 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1629 * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1630 */
1631 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1632 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1633 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1634 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1635 };
1636
1637 /**
1638 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1639 *
1640 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1641 *
1642 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1643 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1644 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1645 * power per-interface or per-station.
1646 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1647 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1648 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1649 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1650 * per peer TPC.
1651 */
1652 struct sta_txpwr {
1653 s16 power;
1654 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1655 };
1656
1657 /**
1658 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters
1659 *
1660 * Used to change and create a new link station.
1661 *
1662 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1663 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station)
1664 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link
1665 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1666 * (or NULL for no change)
1667 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1668 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1669 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1670 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1671 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1672 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1673 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1674 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1675 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set
1676 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1677 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station
1678 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities
1679 */
1680 struct link_station_parameters {
1681 const u8 *mld_mac;
1682 int link_id;
1683 const u8 *link_mac;
1684 const u8 *supported_rates;
1685 u8 supported_rates_len;
1686 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1687 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1688 u8 opmode_notif;
1689 bool opmode_notif_used;
1690 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1691 u8 he_capa_len;
1692 struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1693 bool txpwr_set;
1694 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1695 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa;
1696 u8 eht_capa_len;
1697 };
1698
1699 /**
1700 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters
1701 *
1702 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations).
1703 *
1704 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station
1705 * @link_id: the link id
1706 */
1707 struct link_station_del_parameters {
1708 const u8 *mld_mac;
1709 u32 link_id;
1710 };
1711
1712 /**
1713 * struct cfg80211_ttlm_params: TID to link mapping parameters
1714 *
1715 * Used for setting a TID to link mapping.
1716 *
1717 * @dlink: Downlink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1718 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1719 * @ulink: Uplink TID to link mapping, as defined in section 9.4.2.314
1720 * (TID-To-Link Mapping element) in Draft P802.11be_D4.0.
1721 */
1722 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params {
1723 u16 dlink[8];
1724 u16 ulink[8];
1725 };
1726
1727 /**
1728 * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1729 *
1730 * Used to change and create a new station.
1731 *
1732 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1733 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1734 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1735 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1736 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1737 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1738 * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1739 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1740 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1741 * @plink_action: plink action to take
1742 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1743 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1744 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1745 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1746 * QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1747 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1748 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1749 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1750 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1751 * to unknown)
1752 * @capability: station capability
1753 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1754 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1755 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1756 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1757 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1758 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1759 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1760 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1761 * @link_sta_params: link related params.
1762 */
1763 struct station_parameters {
1764 struct net_device *vlan;
1765 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1766 u32 sta_modify_mask;
1767 int listen_interval;
1768 u16 aid;
1769 u16 vlan_id;
1770 u16 peer_aid;
1771 u8 plink_action;
1772 u8 plink_state;
1773 u8 uapsd_queues;
1774 u8 max_sp;
1775 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1776 u16 capability;
1777 const u8 *ext_capab;
1778 u8 ext_capab_len;
1779 const u8 *supported_channels;
1780 u8 supported_channels_len;
1781 const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1782 u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1783 int support_p2p_ps;
1784 u16 airtime_weight;
1785 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params;
1786 };
1787
1788 /**
1789 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1790 *
1791 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1792 *
1793 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1794 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1795 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1796 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1797 * @link_id: Link ID indicating a link that stations to be flushed must be
1798 * using; valid only for MLO, but can also be -1 for MLO to really
1799 * remove all stations.
1800 */
1801 struct station_del_parameters {
1802 const u8 *mac;
1803 u8 subtype;
1804 u16 reason_code;
1805 int link_id;
1806 };
1807
1808 /**
1809 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1810 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1811 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1812 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1813 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1814 * the AP MLME in the device
1815 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1816 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1817 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1818 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1819 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1820 * supported/used)
1821 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1822 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1823 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1824 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1825 */
1826 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1827 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1828 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1829 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1830 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1831 CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1832 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1833 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1834 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1835 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1836 };
1837
1838 /**
1839 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1840 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1841 * @params: the new parameters for a station
1842 * @statype: the type of station being modified
1843 *
1844 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1845 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1846 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable.
1847 *
1848 * Return: 0 if the change is acceptable, otherwise an error code. Note that
1849 * it may modify the parameters for backward compatibility reasons, so don't
1850 * use them before calling this.
1851 */
1852 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1853 struct station_parameters *params,
1854 enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1855
1856 /**
1857 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1858 *
1859 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1860 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1861 *
1862 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1863 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1864 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1865 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1866 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1867 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1868 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1869 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information
1870 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS
1871 */
1872 enum rate_info_flags {
1873 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0),
1874 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1),
1875 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1876 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3),
1877 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4),
1878 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5),
1879 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6),
1880 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7),
1881 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8),
1882 };
1883
1884 /**
1885 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1886 *
1887 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1888 *
1889 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1890 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1891 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1892 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1893 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1894 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1895 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1896 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth
1897 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation
1898 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth
1899 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth
1900 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth
1901 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth
1902 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth
1903 */
1904 enum rate_info_bw {
1905 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1906 RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1907 RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1908 RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1909 RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1910 RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1911 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1912 RATE_INFO_BW_320,
1913 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU,
1914 RATE_INFO_BW_1,
1915 RATE_INFO_BW_2,
1916 RATE_INFO_BW_4,
1917 RATE_INFO_BW_8,
1918 RATE_INFO_BW_16,
1919 };
1920
1921 /**
1922 * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1923 *
1924 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1925 *
1926 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1927 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1928 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate
1929 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1930 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1931 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1932 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1933 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1934 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1935 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1936 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi)
1937 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc,
1938 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU)
1939 */
1940 struct rate_info {
1941 u16 flags;
1942 u16 legacy;
1943 u8 mcs;
1944 u8 nss;
1945 u8 bw;
1946 u8 he_gi;
1947 u8 he_dcm;
1948 u8 he_ru_alloc;
1949 u8 n_bonded_ch;
1950 u8 eht_gi;
1951 u8 eht_ru_alloc;
1952 };
1953
1954 /**
1955 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1956 *
1957 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1958 * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1959 *
1960 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1961 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1962 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1963 */
1964 enum bss_param_flags {
1965 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = BIT(0),
1966 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(1),
1967 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = BIT(2),
1968 };
1969
1970 /**
1971 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1972 *
1973 * Information about the currently associated BSS
1974 *
1975 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1976 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1977 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1978 */
1979 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1980 u8 flags;
1981 u8 dtim_period;
1982 u16 beacon_interval;
1983 };
1984
1985 /**
1986 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1987 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1988 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1989 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1990 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1991 * @flows: number of new flows seen
1992 * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1993 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1994 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1995 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1996 * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1997 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1998 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1999 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
2000 */
2001 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
2002 u32 filled;
2003 u32 backlog_bytes;
2004 u32 backlog_packets;
2005 u32 flows;
2006 u32 drops;
2007 u32 ecn_marks;
2008 u32 overlimit;
2009 u32 overmemory;
2010 u32 collisions;
2011 u32 tx_bytes;
2012 u32 tx_packets;
2013 u32 max_flows;
2014 };
2015
2016 /**
2017 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
2018 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
2019 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
2020 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
2021 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
2022 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
2023 * transmitted MSDUs
2024 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
2025 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
2026 */
2027 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
2028 u32 filled;
2029 u64 rx_msdu;
2030 u64 tx_msdu;
2031 u64 tx_msdu_retries;
2032 u64 tx_msdu_failed;
2033 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
2034 };
2035
2036 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4
2037
2038 /**
2039 * struct station_info - station information
2040 *
2041 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
2042 *
2043 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
2044 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
2045 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
2046 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
2047 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
2048 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
2049 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
2050 * @llid: mesh local link id
2051 * @plid: mesh peer link id
2052 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
2053 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2054 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2055 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
2056 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
2057 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
2058 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
2059 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
2060 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
2061 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
2062 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
2063 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
2064 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
2065 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
2066 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason.
2067 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
2068 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2069 * This number should increase every time the list of stations
2070 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2071 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2072 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
2073 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
2074 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
2075 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
2076 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
2077 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
2078 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
2079 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
2080 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
2081 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
2082 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
2083 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
2084 * towards this station.
2085 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
2086 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
2087 * from this peer
2088 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
2089 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
2090 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
2091 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
2092 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
2093 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
2094 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
2095 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
2096 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
2097 * been sent.
2098 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
2099 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
2100 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
2101 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
2102 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
2103 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
2104 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled
2105 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP
2106 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this
2107 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2108 * dump_station() callbacks.
2109 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station
2110 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO
2111 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD.
2112 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station.
2113 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros.
2114 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response.
2115 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user
2116 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the
2117 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't
2118 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and
2119 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine
2120 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station.
2121 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets.
2122 */
2123 struct station_info {
2124 u64 filled;
2125 u32 connected_time;
2126 u32 inactive_time;
2127 u64 assoc_at;
2128 u64 rx_bytes;
2129 u64 tx_bytes;
2130 u16 llid;
2131 u16 plid;
2132 u8 plink_state;
2133 s8 signal;
2134 s8 signal_avg;
2135
2136 u8 chains;
2137 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2138 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2139
2140 struct rate_info txrate;
2141 struct rate_info rxrate;
2142 u32 rx_packets;
2143 u32 tx_packets;
2144 u32 tx_retries;
2145 u32 tx_failed;
2146 u32 rx_dropped_misc;
2147 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
2148 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
2149
2150 int generation;
2151
2152 const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
2153 size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
2154
2155 u32 beacon_loss_count;
2156 s64 t_offset;
2157 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
2158 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
2159 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
2160
2161 u32 expected_throughput;
2162
2163 u64 tx_duration;
2164 u64 rx_duration;
2165 u64 rx_beacon;
2166 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
2167 u8 connected_to_gate;
2168
2169 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
2170 s8 ack_signal;
2171 s8 avg_ack_signal;
2172
2173 u16 airtime_weight;
2174
2175 u32 rx_mpdu_count;
2176 u32 fcs_err_count;
2177
2178 u32 airtime_link_metric;
2179
2180 u8 connected_to_as;
2181
2182 bool mlo_params_valid;
2183 u8 assoc_link_id;
2184 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2185 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies;
2186 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len;
2187 };
2188
2189 /**
2190 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
2191 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
2192 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
2193 */
2194 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
2195 s32 power;
2196 u32 freq_range_index;
2197 };
2198
2199 /**
2200 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
2201 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
2202 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
2203 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
2204 */
2205 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
2206 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2207 u32 num_sub_specs;
2208 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[] __counted_by(num_sub_specs);
2209 };
2210
2211
2212 /**
2213 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
2214 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency
2215 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency
2216 */
2217 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
2218 u32 start_freq;
2219 u32 end_freq;
2220 };
2221
2222 /**
2223 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
2224 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
2225 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
2226 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
2227 *
2228 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
2229 * range to small ones and then append them.
2230 */
2231 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
2232 enum nl80211_sar_type type;
2233 u32 num_freq_ranges;
2234 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
2235 };
2236
2237 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
2238 /**
2239 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
2240 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
2241 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
2242 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
2243 *
2244 * Return: 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
2245 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
2246 * considered undefined.
2247 */
2248 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
2249 struct station_info *sinfo);
2250 #else
cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,struct station_info * sinfo)2251 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
2252 const u8 *mac_addr,
2253 struct station_info *sinfo)
2254 {
2255 return -ENOENT;
2256 }
2257 #endif
2258
2259 /**
2260 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
2261 *
2262 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
2263 * according to the nl80211 flags.
2264 *
2265 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
2266 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
2267 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
2268 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
2269 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
2270 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
2271 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
2272 */
2273 enum monitor_flags {
2274 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = BIT(__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID),
2275 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL),
2276 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL),
2277 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL),
2278 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS),
2279 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES),
2280 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = BIT(NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE),
2281 };
2282
2283 /**
2284 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags
2285 *
2286 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
2287 * in during get_station() or dump_station().
2288 *
2289 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
2290 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
2291 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
2292 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
2293 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
2294 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
2295 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
2296 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
2297 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
2298 */
2299 enum mpath_info_flags {
2300 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0),
2301 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1),
2302 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2),
2303 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3),
2304 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4),
2305 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5),
2306 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6),
2307 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7),
2308 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8),
2309 };
2310
2311 /**
2312 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
2313 *
2314 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
2315 *
2316 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
2317 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
2318 * @sn: target sequence number
2319 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
2320 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
2321 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags
2322 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
2323 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
2324 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
2325 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
2326 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
2327 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
2328 * @hop_count: hops to destination
2329 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
2330 */
2331 struct mpath_info {
2332 u32 filled;
2333 u32 frame_qlen;
2334 u32 sn;
2335 u32 metric;
2336 u32 exptime;
2337 u32 discovery_timeout;
2338 u8 discovery_retries;
2339 u8 flags;
2340 u8 hop_count;
2341 u32 path_change_count;
2342
2343 int generation;
2344 };
2345
2346 /**
2347 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
2348 *
2349 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
2350 *
2351 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2352 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
2353 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2354 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
2355 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2356 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
2357 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2358 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
2359 * (or NULL for no change)
2360 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
2361 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
2362 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
2363 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
2364 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
2365 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
2366 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
2367 */
2368 struct bss_parameters {
2369 int link_id;
2370 int use_cts_prot;
2371 int use_short_preamble;
2372 int use_short_slot_time;
2373 const u8 *basic_rates;
2374 u8 basic_rates_len;
2375 int ap_isolate;
2376 int ht_opmode;
2377 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
2378 };
2379
2380 /**
2381 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
2382 *
2383 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
2384 *
2385 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
2386 * by the Mesh Peering Open message
2387 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
2388 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message
2389 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
2390 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
2391 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
2392 * mesh interface
2393 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
2394 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
2395 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
2396 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
2397 * elements
2398 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
2399 * detect compatible mesh peers
2400 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
2401 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
2402 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
2403 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
2404 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
2405 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
2406 * a path discovery in milliseconds
2407 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2408 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
2409 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
2410 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2411 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
2412 * element
2413 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
2414 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
2415 * element
2416 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
2417 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
2418 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
2419 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
2420 * announcements are transmitted
2421 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
2422 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
2423 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
2424 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
2425 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
2426 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
2427 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
2428 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
2429 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
2430 * station to establish a peer link
2431 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
2432 *
2433 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
2434 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
2435 * the root mesh STA to be valid.
2436 *
2437 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
2438 * PREQs are transmitted.
2439 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
2440 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
2441 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
2442 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
2443 * setting for new peer links.
2444 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
2445 * after transmitting its beacon.
2446 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
2447 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2448 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes.
2449 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA
2450 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server
2451 * in the mesh formation field.
2452 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2453 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the
2454 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2455 * in the mesh path table
2456 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2457 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2458 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2459 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2460 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2461 */
2462 struct mesh_config {
2463 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2464 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2465 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2466 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2467 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2468 u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2469 u8 element_ttl;
2470 bool auto_open_plinks;
2471 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2472 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2473 u32 path_refresh_time;
2474 u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2475 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2476 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2477 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2478 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2479 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2480 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2481 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2482 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2483 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2484 bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2485 s32 rssi_threshold;
2486 u16 ht_opmode;
2487 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2488 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2489 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2490 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2491 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2492 u32 plink_timeout;
2493 bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2494 };
2495
2496 /**
2497 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2498 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2499 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2500 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2501 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2502 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2503 * @path_metric: which metric to use
2504 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2505 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2506 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2507 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2508 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2509 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2510 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2511 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2512 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2513 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2514 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2515 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2516 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2517 * to operate on DFS channels.
2518 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2519 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2520 *
2521 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2522 */
2523 struct mesh_setup {
2524 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2525 const u8 *mesh_id;
2526 u8 mesh_id_len;
2527 u8 sync_method;
2528 u8 path_sel_proto;
2529 u8 path_metric;
2530 u8 auth_id;
2531 const u8 *ie;
2532 u8 ie_len;
2533 bool is_authenticated;
2534 bool is_secure;
2535 bool user_mpm;
2536 u8 dtim_period;
2537 u16 beacon_interval;
2538 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2539 u32 basic_rates;
2540 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2541 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2542 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2543 };
2544
2545 /**
2546 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2547 * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2548 *
2549 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2550 */
2551 struct ocb_setup {
2552 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2553 };
2554
2555 /**
2556 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2557 * @ac: AC identifier
2558 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2559 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2560 * 1..32767]
2561 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2562 * 1..32767]
2563 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2564 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD
2565 */
2566 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2567 enum nl80211_ac ac;
2568 u16 txop;
2569 u16 cwmin;
2570 u16 cwmax;
2571 u8 aifs;
2572 int link_id;
2573 };
2574
2575 /**
2576 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2577 *
2578 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2579 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2580 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2581 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2582 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2583 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2584 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2585 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2586 * in the wiphy structure.
2587 *
2588 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2589 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2590 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2591 *
2592 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2593 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2594 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2595 * to userspace.
2596 */
2597
2598 /**
2599 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2600 * @ssid: the SSID
2601 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2602 */
2603 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2604 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2605 u8 ssid_len;
2606 };
2607
2608 /**
2609 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2610 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2611 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2612 * information is not available, this field is left zero.
2613 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2614 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2615 * userspace will be notified of that
2616 */
2617 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2618 u64 scan_start_tsf;
2619 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2620 bool aborted;
2621 };
2622
2623 /**
2624 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2625 *
2626 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for
2627 * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2628 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2629 * which the above info is relevant to
2630 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2631 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used
2632 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2633 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2634 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value.
2635 */
2636 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2637 u32 short_ssid;
2638 u32 channel_idx;
2639 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2640 bool unsolicited_probe;
2641 bool short_ssid_valid;
2642 bool psc_no_listen;
2643 s8 psd_20;
2644 };
2645
2646 /**
2647 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2648 *
2649 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2650 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2651 * @channels: channels to scan on.
2652 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2653 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2654 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2655 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2656 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2657 * the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2658 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2659 * %duration field.
2660 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2661 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2662 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2663 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2664 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2665 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2666 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2667 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2668 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2669 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2670 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2671 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2672 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2673 * true if this is the second scan request
2674 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2675 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2676 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2677 * @tsf_report_link_id: for MLO, indicates the link ID of the BSS that should be
2678 * used for TSF reporting. Can be set to -1 to indicate no preference.
2679 */
2680 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2681 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2682 int n_ssids;
2683 u32 n_channels;
2684 const u8 *ie;
2685 size_t ie_len;
2686 u16 duration;
2687 bool duration_mandatory;
2688 u32 flags;
2689
2690 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2691
2692 struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2693
2694 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2695 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2696 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2697
2698 /* internal */
2699 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2700 unsigned long scan_start;
2701 struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2702 bool notified;
2703 bool no_cck;
2704 bool scan_6ghz;
2705 u32 n_6ghz_params;
2706 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2707 s8 tsf_report_link_id;
2708
2709 /* keep last */
2710 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2711 };
2712
get_random_mask_addr(u8 * buf,const u8 * addr,const u8 * mask)2713 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2714 {
2715 int i;
2716
2717 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2718 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2719 buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2720 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2721 }
2722 }
2723
2724 /**
2725 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2726 *
2727 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2728 * or no match (RSSI only)
2729 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2730 * or no match (RSSI only)
2731 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2732 */
2733 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2734 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2735 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2736 s32 rssi_thold;
2737 };
2738
2739 /**
2740 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2741 *
2742 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2743 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2744 * infinite loop.
2745 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2746 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2747 */
2748 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2749 u32 interval;
2750 u32 iterations;
2751 };
2752
2753 /**
2754 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2755 *
2756 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2757 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2758 */
2759 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2760 enum nl80211_band band;
2761 s8 delta;
2762 };
2763
2764 /**
2765 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2766 *
2767 * @reqid: identifies this request.
2768 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2769 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2770 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2771 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2772 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2773 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags
2774 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2775 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2776 * (others are filtered out).
2777 * If omitted, all results are passed.
2778 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2779 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2780 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2781 * @dev: the interface
2782 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2783 * @channels: channels to scan
2784 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2785 * contains the minimum over all matchsets
2786 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2787 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2788 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2789 * be taken from the @mac_addr
2790 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2791 * index must be executed first.
2792 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2793 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2794 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2795 * owned by a particular socket)
2796 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2797 * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2798 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2799 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2800 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2801 * supported.
2802 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2803 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2804 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2805 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2806 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2807 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2808 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2809 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2810 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2811 * comparisons.
2812 */
2813 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2814 u64 reqid;
2815 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2816 int n_ssids;
2817 u32 n_channels;
2818 const u8 *ie;
2819 size_t ie_len;
2820 u32 flags;
2821 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2822 int n_match_sets;
2823 s32 min_rssi_thold;
2824 u32 delay;
2825 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2826 int n_scan_plans;
2827
2828 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2829 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2830
2831 bool relative_rssi_set;
2832 s8 relative_rssi;
2833 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2834
2835 /* internal */
2836 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2837 struct net_device *dev;
2838 unsigned long scan_start;
2839 bool report_results;
2840 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2841 u32 owner_nlportid;
2842 bool nl_owner_dead;
2843 struct list_head list;
2844
2845 /* keep last */
2846 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
2847 };
2848
2849 /**
2850 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2851 *
2852 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2853 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2854 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2855 */
2856 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2857 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2858 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2859 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2860 };
2861
2862 /**
2863 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2864 * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2865 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2866 * signal type
2867 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2868 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2869 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2870 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2871 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2872 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2873 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2874 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2875 * by %parent_bssid.
2876 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2877 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2878 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2879 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2880 * @restrict_use: restrict usage, if not set, assume @use_for is
2881 * %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
2882 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2883 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2884 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2885 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2886 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2887 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss
2888 */
2889 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2890 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2891 s32 signal;
2892 u64 boottime_ns;
2893 u64 parent_tsf;
2894 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2895 u8 chains;
2896 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2897
2898 u8 restrict_use:1, use_for:7;
2899 u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2900
2901 void *drv_data;
2902 };
2903
2904 /**
2905 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2906 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2907 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2908 * @len: length of the IEs
2909 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2910 * @data: IE data
2911 */
2912 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2913 u64 tsf;
2914 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2915 int len;
2916 bool from_beacon;
2917 u8 data[];
2918 };
2919
2920 /**
2921 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2922 *
2923 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2924 * for use in scan results and similar.
2925 *
2926 * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2927 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2928 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2929 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2930 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2931 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2932 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2933 * received. It is always non-%NULL.
2934 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2935 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2936 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2937 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2938 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2939 * @proberesp_ecsa_stuck: ECSA element is stuck in the Probe Response frame,
2940 * cannot rely on it having valid data
2941 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2942 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2943 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2944 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2945 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2946 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2947 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2948 * (multi-BSSID support)
2949 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2950 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2951 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2952 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2953 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2954 * @use_for: bitmap of possible usage for this BSS, see
2955 * &enum nl80211_bss_use_for
2956 * @cannot_use_reasons: the reasons (bitmap) for not being able to connect,
2957 * if @restrict_use is set and @use_for is zero (empty); may be 0 for
2958 * unspecified reasons; see &enum nl80211_bss_cannot_use_reasons
2959 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2960 */
2961 struct cfg80211_bss {
2962 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2963
2964 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2965 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2966 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2967
2968 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2969 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2970 struct list_head nontrans_list;
2971
2972 s32 signal;
2973
2974 u16 beacon_interval;
2975 u16 capability;
2976
2977 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2978 u8 chains;
2979 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2980
2981 u8 proberesp_ecsa_stuck:1;
2982
2983 u8 bssid_index;
2984 u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2985
2986 u8 use_for;
2987 u8 cannot_use_reasons;
2988
2989 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2990 };
2991
2992 /**
2993 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2994 * @bss: the bss to search
2995 * @id: the element ID
2996 *
2997 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2998 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2999 * Return: %NULL if not found.
3000 */
3001 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
3002
3003 /**
3004 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
3005 * @bss: the bss to search
3006 * @id: the element ID
3007 *
3008 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
3009 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
3010 * Return: %NULL if not found.
3011 */
ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss * bss,u8 id)3012 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
3013 {
3014 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
3015 }
3016
3017
3018 /**
3019 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
3020 *
3021 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3022 * authentication.
3023 *
3024 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
3025 * to it if it needs to keep it.
3026 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3027 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
3028 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3029 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3030 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3031 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3032 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
3033 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
3034 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
3035 * transaction sequence number field.
3036 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
3037 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD,
3038 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the
3039 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and
3040 * given an MLD address) by the driver
3041 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with
3042 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0
3043 */
3044 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
3045 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3046 const u8 *ie;
3047 size_t ie_len;
3048 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3049 const u8 *key;
3050 u8 key_len;
3051 s8 key_idx;
3052 const u8 *auth_data;
3053 size_t auth_data_len;
3054 s8 link_id;
3055 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3056 };
3057
3058 /**
3059 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association
3060 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss;
3061 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested
3062 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link
3063 * @elems_len: length of the elements
3064 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it
3065 * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD.
3066 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the
3067 * operation as a whole must fail.
3068 */
3069 struct cfg80211_assoc_link {
3070 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3071 const u8 *elems;
3072 size_t elems_len;
3073 bool disabled;
3074 int error;
3075 };
3076
3077 /**
3078 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
3079 *
3080 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n)
3081 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT
3082 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
3083 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
3084 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
3085 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
3086 * request (connect callback).
3087 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE
3088 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT
3089 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links.
3090 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this
3091 * flag is not set.
3092 * @ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs will be used on this connection (if any)
3093 */
3094 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
3095 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0),
3096 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1),
3097 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2),
3098 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3),
3099 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4),
3100 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5),
3101 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6),
3102 ASSOC_REQ_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(7),
3103 };
3104
3105 /**
3106 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
3107 *
3108 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3109 * (re)association.
3110 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
3111 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
3112 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
3113 * association requests while already associating must be rejected.
3114 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead
3115 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations.
3116 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
3117 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3118 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
3119 * @crypto: crypto settings
3120 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3121 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3122 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3123 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3124 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3125 * frame.
3126 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3127 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3128 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3129 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3130 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
3131 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
3132 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
3133 * %NULL if FILS is not used.
3134 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
3135 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
3136 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
3137 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
3138 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
3139 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
3140 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections
3141 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates
3142 * the link on which the association request should be sent
3143 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request,
3144 * valid iff @link_id >= 0
3145 */
3146 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
3147 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
3148 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
3149 size_t ie_len;
3150 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3151 bool use_mfp;
3152 u32 flags;
3153 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3154 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3155 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
3156 const u8 *fils_kek;
3157 size_t fils_kek_len;
3158 const u8 *fils_nonces;
3159 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
3160 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
3161 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
3162 s8 link_id;
3163 };
3164
3165 /**
3166 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
3167 *
3168 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3169 * deauthentication.
3170 *
3171 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from
3172 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
3173 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3174 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
3175 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
3176 * do not set a deauth frame
3177 */
3178 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
3179 const u8 *bssid;
3180 const u8 *ie;
3181 size_t ie_len;
3182 u16 reason_code;
3183 bool local_state_change;
3184 };
3185
3186 /**
3187 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
3188 *
3189 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3190 * disassociation.
3191 *
3192 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from
3193 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
3194 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
3195 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
3196 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
3197 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
3198 */
3199 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
3200 const u8 *ap_addr;
3201 const u8 *ie;
3202 size_t ie_len;
3203 u16 reason_code;
3204 bool local_state_change;
3205 };
3206
3207 /**
3208 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
3209 *
3210 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
3211 * method.
3212 *
3213 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
3214 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
3215 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
3216 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
3217 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
3218 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
3219 * IBSSs to join on other channels.
3220 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
3221 * @ie_len: length of that
3222 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
3223 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
3224 * after joining
3225 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
3226 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
3227 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
3228 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
3229 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
3230 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
3231 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
3232 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
3233 * to operate on DFS channels.
3234 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
3235 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
3236 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3237 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3238 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3239 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
3240 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
3241 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
3242 */
3243 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
3244 const u8 *ssid;
3245 const u8 *bssid;
3246 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3247 const u8 *ie;
3248 u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
3249 u16 beacon_interval;
3250 u32 basic_rates;
3251 bool channel_fixed;
3252 bool privacy;
3253 bool control_port;
3254 bool control_port_over_nl80211;
3255 bool userspace_handles_dfs;
3256 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
3257 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3258 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3259 struct key_params *wep_keys;
3260 int wep_tx_key;
3261 };
3262
3263 /**
3264 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
3265 *
3266 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
3267 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
3268 * @param.band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
3269 * @param.adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
3270 */
3271 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
3272 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
3273 union {
3274 enum nl80211_band band_pref;
3275 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
3276 } param;
3277 };
3278
3279 /**
3280 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
3281 *
3282 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
3283 * authentication and association.
3284 *
3285 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
3286 * on scan results)
3287 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
3288 * %NULL if not specified
3289 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
3290 * results)
3291 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
3292 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
3293 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
3294 * to use.
3295 * @ssid: SSID
3296 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
3297 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
3298 * @ie: IEs for association request
3299 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
3300 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
3301 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
3302 * @crypto: crypto settings
3303 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
3304 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
3305 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
3306 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
3307 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds
3308 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
3309 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask
3310 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored.
3311 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
3312 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides
3313 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
3314 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
3315 * networks.
3316 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
3317 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
3318 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
3319 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
3320 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
3321 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
3322 * frame.
3323 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
3324 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
3325 * data IE.
3326 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
3327 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
3328 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
3329 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3330 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
3331 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
3332 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
3333 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
3334 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
3335 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
3336 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
3337 * offload of 4-way handshake.
3338 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
3339 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
3340 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
3341 */
3342 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
3343 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
3344 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
3345 const u8 *bssid;
3346 const u8 *bssid_hint;
3347 const u8 *ssid;
3348 size_t ssid_len;
3349 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
3350 const u8 *ie;
3351 size_t ie_len;
3352 bool privacy;
3353 enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
3354 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
3355 const u8 *key;
3356 u8 key_len, key_idx;
3357 u32 flags;
3358 int bg_scan_period;
3359 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
3360 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
3361 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
3362 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
3363 bool pbss;
3364 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
3365 const u8 *prev_bssid;
3366 const u8 *fils_erp_username;
3367 size_t fils_erp_username_len;
3368 const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
3369 size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
3370 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
3371 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
3372 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
3373 bool want_1x;
3374 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
3375 };
3376
3377 /**
3378 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
3379 *
3380 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
3381 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
3382 *
3383 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
3384 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
3385 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
3386 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
3387 */
3388 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
3389 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0),
3390 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1),
3391 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2),
3392 };
3393
3394 /**
3395 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
3396 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
3397 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
3398 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
3399 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
3400 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
3401 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
3402 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
3403 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
3404 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
3405 */
3406 enum wiphy_params_flags {
3407 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = BIT(0),
3408 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = BIT(1),
3409 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = BIT(2),
3410 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = BIT(3),
3411 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = BIT(4),
3412 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = BIT(5),
3413 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = BIT(6),
3414 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = BIT(7),
3415 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = BIT(8),
3416 };
3417
3418 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256
3419
3420 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
3421 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000
3422 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000
3423
3424 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
3425 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000
3426
3427 /**
3428 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
3429 *
3430 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
3431 * caching.
3432 *
3433 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
3434 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3435 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
3436 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
3437 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
3438 * the hash algorithm used to generate this.
3439 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
3440 * cache identifier (may be %NULL).
3441 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
3442 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
3443 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
3444 * %NULL).
3445 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
3446 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
3447 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
3448 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
3449 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
3450 * used for it expires.
3451 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
3452 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
3453 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
3454 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
3455 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
3456 */
3457 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
3458 const u8 *bssid;
3459 const u8 *pmkid;
3460 const u8 *pmk;
3461 size_t pmk_len;
3462 const u8 *ssid;
3463 size_t ssid_len;
3464 const u8 *cache_id;
3465 u32 pmk_lifetime;
3466 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
3467 };
3468
3469 /**
3470 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
3471 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
3472 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
3473 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
3474 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
3475 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
3476 *
3477 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
3478 * memory, free @mask only!
3479 */
3480 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
3481 const u8 *mask, *pattern;
3482 int pattern_len;
3483 int pkt_offset;
3484 };
3485
3486 /**
3487 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
3488 *
3489 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
3490 * @src: source IP address
3491 * @dst: destination IP address
3492 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
3493 * @src_port: source port
3494 * @dst_port: destination port
3495 * @payload_len: data payload length
3496 * @payload: data payload buffer
3497 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
3498 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
3499 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
3500 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
3501 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
3502 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
3503 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
3504 */
3505 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
3506 struct socket *sock;
3507 __be32 src, dst;
3508 u16 src_port, dst_port;
3509 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
3510 int payload_len;
3511 const u8 *payload;
3512 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3513 u32 data_interval;
3514 u32 wake_len;
3515 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3516 u32 tokens_size;
3517 /* must be last, variable member */
3518 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3519 };
3520
3521 /**
3522 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3523 *
3524 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3525 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3526 * operating as normal during suspend
3527 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3528 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3529 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3530 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3531 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3532 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3533 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3534 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3535 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3536 * NULL if not configured.
3537 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3538 */
3539 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3540 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3541 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3542 rfkill_release;
3543 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3544 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3545 int n_patterns;
3546 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3547 };
3548
3549 /**
3550 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3551 *
3552 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3553 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3554 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3555 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3556 * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3557 * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3558 */
3559 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3560 int delay;
3561 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3562 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3563 int n_patterns;
3564 };
3565
3566 /**
3567 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3568 *
3569 * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3570 * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3571 * @n_rules: number of rules
3572 */
3573 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3574 int n_rules;
3575 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules rules[] __counted_by(n_rules);
3576 };
3577
3578 /**
3579 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3580 *
3581 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3582 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This
3583 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3584 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3585 * occurred (in MHz)
3586 */
3587 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3588 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3589 int n_channels;
3590 u32 channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
3591 };
3592
3593 /**
3594 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3595 *
3596 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3597 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3598 * match information.
3599 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3600 * the matches that triggered the wake up.
3601 */
3602 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3603 int n_matches;
3604 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[] __counted_by(n_matches);
3605 };
3606
3607 /**
3608 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3609 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3610 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3611 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3612 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3613 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3614 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3615 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3616 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3617 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3618 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3619 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3620 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3621 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3622 * it is.
3623 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3624 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3625 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3626 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3627 * @unprot_deauth_disassoc: woke up due to unprotected deauth or
3628 * disassoc frame (in MFP).
3629 */
3630 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3631 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3632 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3633 rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3634 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens,
3635 unprot_deauth_disassoc;
3636 s32 pattern_idx;
3637 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3638 const void *packet;
3639 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3640 };
3641
3642 /**
3643 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3644 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3645 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3646 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3647 * @kek_len: length of kek
3648 * @kck_len: length of kck
3649 * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3650 */
3651 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3652 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3653 u32 akm;
3654 u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3655 };
3656
3657 /**
3658 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3659 *
3660 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3661 *
3662 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3663 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3664 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3665 */
3666 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3667 u16 md;
3668 const u8 *ie;
3669 size_t ie_len;
3670 };
3671
3672 /**
3673 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3674 *
3675 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3676 *
3677 * @chan: channel to use
3678 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required
3679 * @wait: duration for ROC
3680 * @buf: buffer to transmit
3681 * @len: buffer length
3682 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3683 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3684 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3685 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3686 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note
3687 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the
3688 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA)
3689 */
3690 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3691 struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3692 bool offchan;
3693 unsigned int wait;
3694 const u8 *buf;
3695 size_t len;
3696 bool no_cck;
3697 bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3698 int n_csa_offsets;
3699 const u16 *csa_offsets;
3700 int link_id;
3701 };
3702
3703 /**
3704 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3705 *
3706 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3707 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3708 */
3709 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3710 u8 dscp;
3711 u8 up;
3712 };
3713
3714 /**
3715 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3716 *
3717 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3718 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3719 */
3720 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3721 u8 low;
3722 u8 high;
3723 };
3724
3725 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3726 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21
3727 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16
3728 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3729 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3730
3731 /**
3732 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3733 *
3734 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3735 *
3736 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3737 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3738 * the user priority DSCP range definition
3739 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3740 */
3741 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3742 u8 num_des;
3743 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3744 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3745 };
3746
3747 /**
3748 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3749 *
3750 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3751 *
3752 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3753 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3754 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3755 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3756 */
3757 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3758 u8 master_pref;
3759 u8 bands;
3760 };
3761
3762 /**
3763 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3764 * configuration
3765 *
3766 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3767 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3768 */
3769 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3770 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3771 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3772 };
3773
3774 /**
3775 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3776 *
3777 * @filter: the content of the filter
3778 * @len: the length of the filter
3779 */
3780 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3781 const u8 *filter;
3782 u8 len;
3783 };
3784
3785 /**
3786 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3787 *
3788 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3789 * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3790 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3791 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3792 * implementation specific.
3793 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3794 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3795 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3796 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up
3797 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3798 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3799 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3800 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3801 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3802 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3803 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3804 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3805 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3806 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3807 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3808 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3809 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3810 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3811 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3812 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3813 */
3814 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3815 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3816 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3817 u8 publish_type;
3818 bool close_range;
3819 bool publish_bcast;
3820 bool subscribe_active;
3821 u8 followup_id;
3822 u8 followup_reqid;
3823 struct mac_address followup_dest;
3824 u32 ttl;
3825 const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3826 u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3827 bool srf_include;
3828 const u8 *srf_bf;
3829 u8 srf_bf_len;
3830 u8 srf_bf_idx;
3831 struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3832 int srf_num_macs;
3833 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3834 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3835 u8 num_tx_filters;
3836 u8 num_rx_filters;
3837 u8 instance_id;
3838 u64 cookie;
3839 };
3840
3841 /**
3842 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3843 *
3844 * @aa: authenticator address
3845 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3846 * @pmk: the PMK material
3847 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3848 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3849 * holds PMK-R0.
3850 */
3851 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3852 const u8 *aa;
3853 u8 pmk_len;
3854 const u8 *pmk;
3855 const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3856 };
3857
3858 /**
3859 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3860 *
3861 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3862 *
3863 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3864 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3865 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3866 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3867 * authentication response command interface.
3868 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and
3869 * authentication response command interface.
3870 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3871 * authentication request event interface.
3872 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3873 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3874 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3875 * response command interface (user space to driver).
3876 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3877 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event
3878 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication
3879 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT
3880 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space
3881 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload.
3882 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the
3883 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space
3884 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of
3885 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver
3886 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link
3887 * chosen for the authentication.
3888 */
3889 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3890 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3891 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3892 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3893 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3894 u16 status;
3895 const u8 *pmkid;
3896 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3897 };
3898
3899 /**
3900 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3901 *
3902 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3903 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3904 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3905 * answered
3906 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3907 * successfully answered
3908 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3909 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3910 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions
3911 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3912 * of how much time the responder was busy
3913 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3914 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3915 * the responder
3916 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3917 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3918 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3919 */
3920 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3921 u32 filled;
3922 u32 success_num;
3923 u32 partial_num;
3924 u32 failed_num;
3925 u32 asap_num;
3926 u32 non_asap_num;
3927 u64 total_duration_ms;
3928 u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3929 u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3930 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3931 };
3932
3933 /**
3934 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3935 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3936 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3937 * reason than just "failure"
3938 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3939 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3940 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3941 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3942 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3943 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3944 * by the responder
3945 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3946 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3947 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3948 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3949 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3950 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3951 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3952 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3953 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3954 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3955 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3956 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3957 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3958 * the square root of the variance)
3959 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3960 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3961 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3962 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3963 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3964 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3965 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3966 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3967 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3968 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3969 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3970 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3971 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3972 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3973 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3974 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3975 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3976 */
3977 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3978 const u8 *lci;
3979 const u8 *civicloc;
3980 unsigned int lci_len;
3981 unsigned int civicloc_len;
3982 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3983 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3984 s16 burst_index;
3985 u8 busy_retry_time;
3986 u8 num_bursts_exp;
3987 u8 burst_duration;
3988 u8 ftms_per_burst;
3989 s32 rssi_avg;
3990 s32 rssi_spread;
3991 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3992 s64 rtt_avg;
3993 s64 rtt_variance;
3994 s64 rtt_spread;
3995 s64 dist_avg;
3996 s64 dist_variance;
3997 s64 dist_spread;
3998
3999 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
4000 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
4001 rssi_avg_valid:1,
4002 rssi_spread_valid:1,
4003 tx_rate_valid:1,
4004 rx_rate_valid:1,
4005 rtt_avg_valid:1,
4006 rtt_variance_valid:1,
4007 rtt_spread_valid:1,
4008 dist_avg_valid:1,
4009 dist_variance_valid:1,
4010 dist_spread_valid:1;
4011 };
4012
4013 /**
4014 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
4015 * @addr: address of the peer
4016 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
4017 * measurement was made)
4018 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
4019 * @status: status of the measurement
4020 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
4021 * reporting partial results always set this flag
4022 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
4023 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
4024 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
4025 * they're all aggregated for userspace.
4026 * @ftm: FTM result
4027 */
4028 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
4029 u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
4030 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
4031
4032 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4033
4034 u8 final:1,
4035 ap_tsf_valid:1;
4036
4037 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
4038
4039 union {
4040 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
4041 };
4042 };
4043
4044 /**
4045 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
4046 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
4047 * @preamble: frame preamble to use
4048 * @burst_period: burst period to use
4049 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
4050 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
4051 * @burst_duration: burst duration
4052 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
4053 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
4054 * @request_lci: request LCI information
4055 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
4056 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
4057 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4058 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
4059 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
4060 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
4061 * EDCA based ranging will be used.
4062 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
4063 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
4064 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
4065 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
4066 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
4067 *
4068 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
4069 */
4070 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
4071 enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
4072 u16 burst_period;
4073 u8 requested:1,
4074 asap:1,
4075 request_lci:1,
4076 request_civicloc:1,
4077 trigger_based:1,
4078 non_trigger_based:1,
4079 lmr_feedback:1;
4080 u8 num_bursts_exp;
4081 u8 burst_duration;
4082 u8 ftms_per_burst;
4083 u8 ftmr_retries;
4084 u8 bss_color;
4085 };
4086
4087 /**
4088 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
4089 * @addr: MAC address
4090 * @chandef: channel to use
4091 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
4092 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
4093 */
4094 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
4095 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
4096 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
4097 u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
4098 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
4099 };
4100
4101 /**
4102 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
4103 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
4104 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
4105 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
4106 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
4107 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
4108 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
4109 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
4110 * be taken from the @mac_addr
4111 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
4112 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
4113 * zero it means there's no timeout
4114 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
4115 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
4116 */
4117 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
4118 u64 cookie;
4119 void *drv_data;
4120 u32 n_peers;
4121 u32 nl_portid;
4122
4123 u32 timeout;
4124
4125 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4126 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4127
4128 struct list_head list;
4129
4130 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers);
4131 };
4132
4133 /**
4134 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
4135 *
4136 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
4137 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
4138 *
4139 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
4140 *
4141 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
4142 * has to be done.
4143 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
4144 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
4145 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
4146 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
4147 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
4148 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
4149 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
4150 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
4151 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested
4152 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station
4153 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it
4154 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4155 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO
4156 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when
4157 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only
4158 * with OWE update event (driver to user space).
4159 */
4160 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
4161 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4162 u16 status;
4163 const u8 *ie;
4164 size_t ie_len;
4165 int assoc_link_id;
4166 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
4167 };
4168
4169 /**
4170 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
4171 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4172 * for the entire device
4173 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
4174 * for the given interface
4175 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
4176 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
4177 * for these subtypes
4178 */
4179 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
4180 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
4181 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
4182 };
4183
4184 /**
4185 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
4186 *
4187 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
4188 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
4189 *
4190 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
4191 * on success or a negative error code.
4192 *
4193 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
4194 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
4195 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
4196 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
4197 *
4198 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
4199 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
4200 * configured for the device.
4201 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
4202 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
4203 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
4204 * the device.
4205 *
4206 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
4207 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
4208 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
4209 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
4210 * also set the address member in the wdev.
4211 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4212 *
4213 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
4214 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4215 *
4216 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
4217 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
4218 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
4219 *
4220 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that
4221 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link
4222 * address is available.
4223 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface.
4224 *
4225 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
4226 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection.
4227 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for
4228 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4229 *
4230 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
4231 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
4232 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
4233 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
4234 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
4235 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection,
4236 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr
4237 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key.
4238 *
4239 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
4240 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will
4241 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0
4242 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD
4243 * address for MLO pairwise key.
4244 *
4245 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0
4246 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4247 *
4248 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface.
4249 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4250 *
4251 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface.
4252 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection.
4253 *
4254 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
4255 *
4256 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
4257 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
4258 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
4259 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
4260 *
4261 * @add_station: Add a new station.
4262 * @del_station: Remove a station
4263 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
4264 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
4265 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
4266 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
4267 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
4268 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
4269 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4270 *
4271 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
4272 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
4273 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
4274 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
4275 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4276 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
4277 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
4278 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
4279 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4280 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
4281 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4282 *
4283 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
4284 *
4285 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
4286 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
4287 * set, and which to leave alone.
4288 *
4289 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
4290 *
4291 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data
4292 * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called
4293 * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock.
4294 * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside
4295 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss.
4296 * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed.
4297 *
4298 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
4299 *
4300 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
4301 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
4302 * join the mesh instead.
4303 *
4304 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
4305 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
4306 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
4307 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
4308 *
4309 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
4310 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
4311 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
4312 * the scan/scan_done bracket too.
4313 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
4314 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
4315 *
4316 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
4317 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4318 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
4319 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4320 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
4321 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4322 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
4323 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4324 *
4325 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
4326 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
4327 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
4328 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
4329 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
4330 * was received.
4331 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
4332 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
4333 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
4334 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
4335 * frame instead of Association Request frame.
4336 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
4337 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
4338 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
4339 * indication of requesting reassociation.
4340 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
4341 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
4342 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4343 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
4344 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
4345 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
4346 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
4347 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
4348 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
4349 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
4350 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4351 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
4352 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
4353 * case connection was already established (invoked with the
4354 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
4355 *
4356 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
4357 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
4358 * to a merge.
4359 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4360 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
4361 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4362 *
4363 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
4364 * MESH mode)
4365 *
4366 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
4367 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
4368 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
4369 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
4370 *
4371 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
4372 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
4373 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
4374 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
4375 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
4376 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
4377 * return 0 if successful
4378 *
4379 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
4380 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state
4381 *
4382 * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
4383 *
4384 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
4385 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
4386 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
4387 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
4388 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
4389 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
4390 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
4391 * the duration value.
4392 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
4393 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
4394 * frame on another channel
4395 *
4396 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
4397 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
4398 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
4399 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
4400 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
4401 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
4402 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
4403 *
4404 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
4405 *
4406 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
4407 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
4408 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
4409 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
4410 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
4411 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
4412 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
4413 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
4414 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
4415 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
4416 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
4417 * disabled.)
4418 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
4419 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the
4420 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should
4421 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
4422 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
4423 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
4424 * thresholds.
4425 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
4426 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
4427 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
4428 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
4429 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
4430 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
4431 * stop (when this method returns 0).
4432 *
4433 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
4434 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
4435 *
4436 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4437 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4438 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4439 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4440 *
4441 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4442 *
4443 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
4444 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
4445 *
4446 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
4447 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
4448 *
4449 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
4450 *
4451 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
4452 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
4453 * current monitoring channel.
4454 *
4455 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
4456 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
4457 *
4458 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
4459 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
4460 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
4461 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
4462 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
4463 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
4464 *
4465 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
4466 *
4467 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
4468 * was finished on another phy.
4469 *
4470 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
4471 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
4472 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
4473 *
4474 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
4475 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
4476 * driver can take the most appropriate actions.
4477 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
4478 * reliability. This operation can not fail.
4479 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
4480 *
4481 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
4482 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
4483 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
4484 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
4485 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
4486 * as soon as possible.
4487 *
4488 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
4489 *
4490 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
4491 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
4492 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
4493 *
4494 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
4495 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
4496 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
4497 * account.
4498 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
4499 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
4500 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
4501 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
4502 * rejected)
4503 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
4504 *
4505 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
4506 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4507 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
4508 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4509 *
4510 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4511 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4512 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
4513 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4514 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4515 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
4516 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
4517 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
4518 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
4519 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
4520 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
4521 * cfg80211_free_nan_func().
4522 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
4523 * provided @nan_func.
4524 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
4525 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
4526 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
4527 * All other parameters must be ignored.
4528 *
4529 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
4530 *
4531 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
4532 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
4533 *
4534 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
4535 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
4536 * upon which the driver should clear it.
4537 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4538 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
4539 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
4540 *
4541 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
4542 * user space
4543 *
4544 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter
4545 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
4546 *
4547 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4548 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4549 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
4550 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
4551 *
4552 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
4553 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
4554 * DH IE through this interface.
4555 *
4556 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
4557 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
4558 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
4559 * This callback may sleep.
4560 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
4561 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
4562 *
4563 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4564 *
4565 * @color_change: Initiate a color change.
4566 *
4567 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use
4568 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association
4569 * Response frame.
4570 *
4571 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4572 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4573 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4574 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4575 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4576 * radar channel.
4577 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4578 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4579 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station.
4580 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station.
4581 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station.
4582 *
4583 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames.
4584 * @set_ttlm: set the TID to link mapping.
4585 * @get_radio_mask: get bitmask of radios in use.
4586 * (invoked with the wiphy mutex held)
4587 */
4588 struct cfg80211_ops {
4589 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4590 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4591 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4592
4593 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4594 const char *name,
4595 unsigned char name_assign_type,
4596 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4597 struct vif_params *params);
4598 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4599 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4600 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4601 struct net_device *dev,
4602 enum nl80211_iftype type,
4603 struct vif_params *params);
4604
4605 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4606 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4607 unsigned int link_id);
4608 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4609 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4610 unsigned int link_id);
4611
4612 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4613 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4614 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params);
4615 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4616 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4617 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie,
4618 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4619 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4620 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise,
4621 const u8 *mac_addr);
4622 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4623 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4624 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4625 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4626 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id,
4627 u8 key_index);
4628 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4629 struct net_device *netdev,
4630 int link_id,
4631 u8 key_index);
4632
4633 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4634 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4635 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4636 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info);
4637 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4638 unsigned int link_id);
4639
4640
4641 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4642 const u8 *mac,
4643 struct station_parameters *params);
4644 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4645 struct station_del_parameters *params);
4646 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4647 const u8 *mac,
4648 struct station_parameters *params);
4649 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4650 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4651 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4652 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4653
4654 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4655 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4656 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4657 const u8 *dst);
4658 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4659 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4660 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4661 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4662 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4663 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4664 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4665 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4666 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4667 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4668 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4669 struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4670 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4671 struct net_device *dev,
4672 struct mesh_config *conf);
4673 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4674 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4675 const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4676 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4677 const struct mesh_config *conf,
4678 const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4679 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4680
4681 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4682 struct ocb_setup *setup);
4683 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4684
4685 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4686 struct bss_parameters *params);
4687
4688 void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
4689 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data);
4690
4691 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4692 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4693
4694 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4695 struct net_device *dev,
4696 struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4697
4698 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4699 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4700
4701 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4702 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4703 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4704
4705 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4706 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4707 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4708 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4709 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4710 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4711 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4712 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4713
4714 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4715 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4716 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4717 struct net_device *dev,
4718 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4719 u32 changed);
4720 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4721 u16 reason_code);
4722
4723 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4724 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4725 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4726
4727 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4728 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4729
4730 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4731
4732 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4733 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4734 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4735 int *dbm);
4736
4737 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4738
4739 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4740 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4741 void *data, int len);
4742 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4743 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4744 void *data, int len);
4745 #endif
4746
4747 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4748 struct net_device *dev,
4749 unsigned int link_id,
4750 const u8 *peer,
4751 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4752
4753 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4754 int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4755
4756 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4757 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4758 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4759 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4760 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4761
4762 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4763 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4764 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4765 unsigned int duration,
4766 u64 *cookie);
4767 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4768 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4769 u64 cookie);
4770
4771 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4772 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4773 u64 *cookie);
4774 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4775 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4776 u64 cookie);
4777
4778 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4779 bool enabled, int timeout);
4780
4781 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4782 struct net_device *dev,
4783 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4784
4785 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4786 struct net_device *dev,
4787 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4788
4789 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4790 struct net_device *dev,
4791 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4792
4793 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4794 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4795 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4796
4797 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4798 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4799
4800 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4801 struct net_device *dev,
4802 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4803 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4804 u64 reqid);
4805
4806 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4807 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4808
4809 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4810 const u8 *peer, int link_id,
4811 u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code,
4812 u32 peer_capability, bool initiator,
4813 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4814 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4815 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4816
4817 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4818 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4819
4820 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4821 struct net_device *dev,
4822 u16 noack_map);
4823
4824 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4825 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4826 unsigned int link_id,
4827 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4828
4829 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4830 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4831 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4832 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4833
4834 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4835 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4836
4837 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4838 struct net_device *dev,
4839 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4840 u32 cac_time_ms, int link_id);
4841 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4842 struct net_device *dev, unsigned int link_id);
4843 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4844 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4845 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4846 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4847 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4848 u16 duration);
4849 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4850 struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4851 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4852 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4853
4854 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4855 struct net_device *dev,
4856 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4857
4858 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4859 struct net_device *dev,
4860 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4861
4862 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4863 unsigned int link_id,
4864 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4865
4866 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4867 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4868 u16 admitted_time);
4869 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4870 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4871
4872 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4873 struct net_device *dev,
4874 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4875 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4876 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4877 struct net_device *dev,
4878 const u8 *addr);
4879 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4880 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4881 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4882 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4883 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4884 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4885 u64 cookie);
4886 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4887 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4888 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4889 u32 changes);
4890
4891 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4892 struct net_device *dev,
4893 const bool enabled);
4894
4895 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4896 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4897 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4898
4899 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4900 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4901 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4902 const u8 *aa);
4903 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4904 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4905
4906 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4907 struct net_device *dev,
4908 const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4909 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4910 const bool noencrypt, int link_id,
4911 u64 *cookie);
4912
4913 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4914 struct net_device *dev,
4915 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4916
4917 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4918 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4919 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4920 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4921 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4922 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4923 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4924 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4925 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4926 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4927 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4928 const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4929 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4930 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4931 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4932 struct net_device *dev,
4933 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params);
4934 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4935 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad);
4936 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4937 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4938 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4939 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4940 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4941 struct link_station_parameters *params);
4942 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4943 struct link_station_del_parameters *params);
4944 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4945 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4946 int (*set_ttlm)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4947 struct cfg80211_ttlm_params *params);
4948 u32 (*get_radio_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4949 };
4950
4951 /*
4952 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4953 * and registration/helper functions
4954 */
4955
4956 /**
4957 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4958 *
4959 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4960 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for 6 GHz.
4961 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4962 * wiphy at all
4963 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4964 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4965 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4966 * reason to override the default
4967 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4968 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4969 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4970 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4971 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4972 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4973 * control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4974 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4975 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4976 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4977 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4978 * firmware.
4979 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4980 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4981 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4982 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4983 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4984 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4985 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4986 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4987 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4988 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4989 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4990 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4991 * responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4992 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4993 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4994 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4995 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4996 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4997 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4998 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs,
4999 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have
5000 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver
5001 * should set this flag for now.
5002 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys.
5003 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for
5004 * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER.
5005 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver
5006 * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints.
5007 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY: support connection to non-primary link
5008 * of an NSTR mobile AP MLD.
5009 * @WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT: disable wireless extensions for this device
5010 */
5011 enum wiphy_flags {
5012 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0),
5013 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1),
5014 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2),
5015 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3),
5016 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4),
5017 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5),
5018 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6),
5019 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7),
5020 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8),
5021 WIPHY_FLAG_DISABLE_WEXT = BIT(9),
5022 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10),
5023 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11),
5024 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_NSTR_NONPRIMARY = BIT(12),
5025 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13),
5026 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14),
5027 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15),
5028 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16),
5029 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17),
5030 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18),
5031 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19),
5032 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20),
5033 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21),
5034 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22),
5035 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23),
5036 WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24),
5037 WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25),
5038 };
5039
5040 /**
5041 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
5042 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
5043 * @types: interface types (bits)
5044 */
5045 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
5046 u16 max;
5047 u16 types;
5048 };
5049
5050 /**
5051 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
5052 *
5053 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
5054 * combinations it supports concurrently. When set in a struct wiphy_radio,
5055 * the combinations refer to combinations of interfaces currently active on
5056 * that radio.
5057 *
5058 * Examples:
5059 *
5060 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
5061 *
5062 * .. code-block:: c
5063 *
5064 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
5065 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5066 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), },
5067 * };
5068 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
5069 * .limits = limits1,
5070 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
5071 * .max_interfaces = 2,
5072 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true,
5073 * };
5074 *
5075 *
5076 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
5077 *
5078 * .. code-block:: c
5079 *
5080 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
5081 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
5082 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
5083 * };
5084 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
5085 * .limits = limits2,
5086 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
5087 * .max_interfaces = 8,
5088 * .num_different_channels = 1,
5089 * };
5090 *
5091 *
5092 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
5093 *
5094 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
5095 *
5096 * .. code-block:: c
5097 *
5098 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
5099 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
5100 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
5101 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
5102 * };
5103 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
5104 * .limits = limits3,
5105 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
5106 * .max_interfaces = 4,
5107 * .num_different_channels = 2,
5108 * };
5109 *
5110 */
5111 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
5112 /**
5113 * @limits:
5114 * limits for the given interface types
5115 */
5116 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
5117
5118 /**
5119 * @num_different_channels:
5120 * can use up to this many different channels
5121 */
5122 u32 num_different_channels;
5123
5124 /**
5125 * @max_interfaces:
5126 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
5127 */
5128 u16 max_interfaces;
5129
5130 /**
5131 * @n_limits:
5132 * number of limitations
5133 */
5134 u8 n_limits;
5135
5136 /**
5137 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
5138 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
5139 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
5140 */
5141 bool beacon_int_infra_match;
5142
5143 /**
5144 * @radar_detect_widths:
5145 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
5146 */
5147 u8 radar_detect_widths;
5148
5149 /**
5150 * @radar_detect_regions:
5151 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
5152 */
5153 u8 radar_detect_regions;
5154
5155 /**
5156 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
5157 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
5158 *
5159 * = 0
5160 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
5161 * > 0
5162 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
5163 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
5164 * combination must be greater or equal to this value.
5165 */
5166 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
5167 };
5168
5169 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
5170 u16 tx, rx;
5171 };
5172
5173 /**
5174 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
5175 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
5176 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
5177 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
5178 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the
5179 * packet should be preserved in that case
5180 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
5181 * (see nl80211.h)
5182 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
5183 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
5184 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
5185 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
5186 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
5187 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
5188 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
5189 */
5190 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
5191 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0),
5192 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1),
5193 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2),
5194 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3),
5195 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4),
5196 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5),
5197 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6),
5198 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7),
5199 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8),
5200 };
5201
5202 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
5203 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
5204 u32 data_payload_max;
5205 u32 data_interval_max;
5206 u32 wake_payload_max;
5207 bool seq;
5208 };
5209
5210 /**
5211 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
5212 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
5213 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
5214 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5215 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5216 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5217 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5218 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
5219 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
5220 * scheduled scans.
5221 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
5222 * details.
5223 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
5224 */
5225 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
5226 u32 flags;
5227 int n_patterns;
5228 int pattern_max_len;
5229 int pattern_min_len;
5230 int max_pkt_offset;
5231 int max_nd_match_sets;
5232 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
5233 };
5234
5235 /**
5236 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
5237 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
5238 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
5239 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
5240 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
5241 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
5242 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
5243 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
5244 */
5245 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
5246 int n_rules;
5247 int max_delay;
5248 int n_patterns;
5249 int pattern_max_len;
5250 int pattern_min_len;
5251 int max_pkt_offset;
5252 };
5253
5254 /**
5255 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
5256 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
5257 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
5258 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
5259 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
5260 */
5261 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
5262 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
5263 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
5264 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
5265 };
5266
5267 /**
5268 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
5269 *
5270 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
5271 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
5272 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
5273 *
5274 */
5275 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
5276 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
5277 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1),
5278 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2),
5279 };
5280
5281 /**
5282 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
5283 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
5284 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
5285 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
5286 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
5287 */
5288
5289 struct sta_opmode_info {
5290 u32 changed;
5291 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
5292 enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
5293 u8 rx_nss;
5294 };
5295
5296 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
5297
5298 /**
5299 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
5300 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
5301 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
5302 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
5303 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
5304 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
5305 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
5306 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
5307 * dumpit calls.
5308 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
5309 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
5310 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
5311 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
5312 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
5313 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
5314 * are used with dump requests.
5315 */
5316 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
5317 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
5318 u32 flags;
5319 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5320 const void *data, int data_len);
5321 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
5322 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
5323 unsigned long *storage);
5324 const struct nla_policy *policy;
5325 unsigned int maxattr;
5326 };
5327
5328 /**
5329 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
5330 * @iftype: interface type
5331 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5332 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
5333 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
5334 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
5335 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
5336 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5337 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5338 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO)
5339 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO)
5340 */
5341 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
5342 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5343 const u8 *extended_capabilities;
5344 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
5345 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5346 u16 eml_capabilities;
5347 u16 mld_capa_and_ops;
5348 };
5349
5350 /**
5351 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability
5352 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from
5353 * @type: the interface type to look up
5354 *
5355 * Return: The extended capability for the given interface @type, may be %NULL
5356 */
5357 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *
5358 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type);
5359
5360 /**
5361 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
5362 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
5363 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
5364 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
5365 * @ftm: FTM measurement data
5366 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
5367 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
5368 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
5369 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
5370 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
5371 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
5372 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
5373 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
5374 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
5375 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
5376 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
5377 * not limited)
5378 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5379 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
5380 */
5381 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
5382 unsigned int max_peers;
5383 u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
5384 randomize_mac_addr:1;
5385
5386 struct {
5387 u32 preambles;
5388 u32 bandwidths;
5389 s8 max_bursts_exponent;
5390 u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
5391 u8 supported:1,
5392 asap:1,
5393 non_asap:1,
5394 request_lci:1,
5395 request_civicloc:1,
5396 trigger_based:1,
5397 non_trigger_based:1;
5398 } ftm;
5399 };
5400
5401 /**
5402 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
5403 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
5404 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
5405 *
5406 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
5407 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
5408 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5409 */
5410 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
5411 u16 iftypes_mask;
5412 const u32 *akm_suites;
5413 int n_akm_suites;
5414 };
5415
5416 /**
5417 * struct wiphy_radio_freq_range - wiphy frequency range
5418 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency (kHz)
5419 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency (kHz)
5420 */
5421 struct wiphy_radio_freq_range {
5422 u32 start_freq;
5423 u32 end_freq;
5424 };
5425
5426
5427 /**
5428 * struct wiphy_radio - physical radio of a wiphy
5429 * This structure describes a physical radio belonging to a wiphy.
5430 * It is used to describe concurrent-channel capabilities. Only one channel
5431 * can be active on the radio described by struct wiphy_radio.
5432 *
5433 * @freq_range: frequency range that the radio can operate on.
5434 * @n_freq_range: number of elements in @freq_range
5435 *
5436 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5437 * list single interface types.
5438 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5439 */
5440 struct wiphy_radio {
5441 const struct wiphy_radio_freq_range *freq_range;
5442 int n_freq_range;
5443
5444 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5445 int n_iface_combinations;
5446 };
5447
5448 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff
5449
5450 /**
5451 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
5452 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
5453 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
5454 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
5455 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
5456 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
5457 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
5458 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
5459 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
5460 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
5461 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
5462 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
5463 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
5464 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
5465 * iftype_akm_suites.
5466 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
5467 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
5468 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
5469 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
5470 * instances of iftype_akm_suites).
5471 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
5472 * suites are specified separately.
5473 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
5474 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
5475 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
5476 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
5477 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
5478 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
5479 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
5480 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
5481 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
5482 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
5483 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
5484 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
5485 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
5486 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
5487 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
5488 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
5489 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
5490 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
5491 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
5492 * unregister hardware
5493 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
5494 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
5495 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
5496 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
5497 * (see below).
5498 * @wext: wireless extension handlers
5499 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
5500 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
5501 * must be set by driver
5502 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
5503 * list single interface types.
5504 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
5505 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
5506 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
5507 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
5508 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
5509 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
5510 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
5511 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
5512 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
5513 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
5514 * this variable determines its size
5515 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
5516 * any given scan
5517 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
5518 * the device can run concurrently.
5519 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
5520 * for in any given scheduled scan
5521 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
5522 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
5523 * supported.
5524 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
5525 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
5526 * include fixed IEs like supported rates
5527 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
5528 * scans
5529 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
5530 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
5531 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
5532 * single scan plan supported by the device.
5533 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
5534 * scan plan supported by the device.
5535 * @coverage_class: current coverage class
5536 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
5537 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
5538 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
5539 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
5540 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
5541 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
5542 *
5543 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
5544 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
5545 * type
5546 *
5547 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5548 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5549 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
5550 *
5551 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
5552 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
5553 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
5554 *
5555 * @probe_resp_offload:
5556 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
5557 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
5558 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
5559 *
5560 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
5561 * may request, if implemented.
5562 *
5563 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
5564 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
5565 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
5566 * to the suspend() operation instead.
5567 *
5568 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
5569 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
5570 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5571 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
5572 * If null, then none can be over-ridden.
5573 *
5574 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
5575 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
5576 *
5577 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
5578 * supports for ACL.
5579 *
5580 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
5581 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
5582 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
5583 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See
5584 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
5585 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
5586 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
5587 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
5588 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
5589 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
5590 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
5591 * capabilities are specified separately.
5592 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
5593 *
5594 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
5595 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
5596 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
5597 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
5598 *
5599 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
5600 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
5601 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
5602 * some cases, but may not always reach.
5603 *
5604 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
5605 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver
5606 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
5607 * infinite.
5608 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
5609 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
5610 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
5611 *
5612 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
5613 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for
5614 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
5615 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
5616 *
5617 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
5618 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
5619 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
5620 *
5621 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
5622 * wake_tx_queue
5623 *
5624 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
5625 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
5626 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
5627 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
5628 *
5629 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
5630 *
5631 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
5632 * device has
5633 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5634 * supported by the driver for each vif
5635 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
5636 * supported by the driver for each peer
5637 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
5638 * long/short retry configuration
5639 *
5640 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
5641 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
5642 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
5643 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
5644 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
5645 *
5646 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver
5647 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value
5648 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support.
5649 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by
5650 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the
5651 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP).
5652 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for
5653 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and
5654 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by
5655 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is
5656 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with
5657 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is
5658 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES.
5659 *
5660 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports
5661 * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a
5662 * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping.
5663 * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver
5664 * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to
5665 * specify a mac address).
5666 *
5667 * @radio: radios belonging to this wiphy
5668 * @n_radio: number of radios
5669 */
5670 struct wiphy {
5671 struct mutex mtx;
5672
5673 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
5674
5675 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
5676 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
5677
5678 struct mac_address *addresses;
5679
5680 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
5681
5682 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
5683 int n_iface_combinations;
5684 u16 software_iftypes;
5685
5686 u16 n_addresses;
5687
5688 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
5689 u16 interface_modes;
5690
5691 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
5692
5693 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
5694 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
5695
5696 u32 ap_sme_capa;
5697
5698 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
5699
5700 int bss_priv_size;
5701 u8 max_scan_ssids;
5702 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
5703 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
5704 u8 max_match_sets;
5705 u16 max_scan_ie_len;
5706 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
5707 u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
5708 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
5709 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
5710
5711 int n_cipher_suites;
5712 const u32 *cipher_suites;
5713
5714 int n_akm_suites;
5715 const u32 *akm_suites;
5716
5717 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5718 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5719
5720 u8 retry_short;
5721 u8 retry_long;
5722 u32 frag_threshold;
5723 u32 rts_threshold;
5724 u8 coverage_class;
5725
5726 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5727 u32 hw_version;
5728
5729 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5730 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5731 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5732 #endif
5733
5734 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5735
5736 u8 max_num_pmkids;
5737
5738 u32 available_antennas_tx;
5739 u32 available_antennas_rx;
5740
5741 u32 probe_resp_offload;
5742
5743 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5744 u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5745
5746 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5747 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5748
5749 const void *privid;
5750
5751 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5752
5753 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5754 struct regulatory_request *request);
5755
5756 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5757
5758 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5759
5760 struct device dev;
5761
5762 bool registered;
5763
5764 struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5765
5766 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5767 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5768
5769 struct list_head wdev_list;
5770
5771 possible_net_t _net;
5772
5773 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5774 const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5775 #endif
5776
5777 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5778
5779 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5780 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5781 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5782
5783 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5784
5785 u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5786
5787 u32 bss_select_support;
5788
5789 u8 nan_supported_bands;
5790
5791 u32 txq_limit;
5792 u32 txq_memory_limit;
5793 u32 txq_quantum;
5794
5795 unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5796
5797 u8 support_mbssid:1,
5798 support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5799
5800 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5801
5802 struct {
5803 u64 peer, vif;
5804 u8 max_retry;
5805 } tid_config_support;
5806
5807 u8 max_data_retry_count;
5808
5809 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5810
5811 struct rfkill *rfkill;
5812
5813 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces;
5814 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity;
5815 u16 max_num_akm_suites;
5816
5817 u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers;
5818
5819 int n_radio;
5820 const struct wiphy_radio *radio;
5821
5822 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5823 };
5824
wiphy_net(struct wiphy * wiphy)5825 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5826 {
5827 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5828 }
5829
wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct net * net)5830 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5831 {
5832 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5833 }
5834
5835 /**
5836 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5837 *
5838 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5839 * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5840 */
wiphy_priv(struct wiphy * wiphy)5841 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5842 {
5843 BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5844 return &wiphy->priv;
5845 }
5846
5847 /**
5848 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5849 *
5850 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5851 * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5852 */
priv_to_wiphy(void * priv)5853 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5854 {
5855 BUG_ON(!priv);
5856 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5857 }
5858
5859 /**
5860 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5861 *
5862 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5863 * @dev: The device to parent it to
5864 */
set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct device * dev)5865 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5866 {
5867 wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5868 }
5869
5870 /**
5871 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5872 *
5873 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5874 * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5875 */
wiphy_dev(struct wiphy * wiphy)5876 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5877 {
5878 return wiphy->dev.parent;
5879 }
5880
5881 /**
5882 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5883 *
5884 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5885 * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5886 */
wiphy_name(const struct wiphy * wiphy)5887 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5888 {
5889 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5890 }
5891
5892 /**
5893 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5894 *
5895 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5896 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5897 * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5898 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5899 *
5900 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5901 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5902 *
5903 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5904 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5905 */
5906 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5907 const char *requested_name);
5908
5909 /**
5910 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5911 *
5912 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5913 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5914 *
5915 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5916 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5917 *
5918 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5919 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5920 */
wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops * ops,int sizeof_priv)5921 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5922 int sizeof_priv)
5923 {
5924 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5925 }
5926
5927 /**
5928 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5929 *
5930 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5931 *
5932 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5933 */
5934 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5935
5936 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5937 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5938
5939 /**
5940 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5941 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5942 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5943 *
5944 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5945 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5946 */
5947 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \
5948 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5949
5950 /**
5951 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5952 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5953 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5954 *
5955 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5956 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5957 */
5958 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \
5959 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5960
5961 /**
5962 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5963 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5964 *
5965 * Context: Requires any of RTNL, wiphy mutex or RCU protection.
5966 *
5967 * Return: pointer to the regulatory domain associated with the wiphy
5968 */
5969 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5970
5971 /**
5972 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5973 *
5974 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5975 *
5976 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5977 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5978 * request that is being handled.
5979 */
5980 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5981
5982 /**
5983 * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5984 *
5985 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5986 */
5987 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5988
5989 /* internal structs */
5990 struct cfg80211_conn;
5991 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5992 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5993 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5994
5995 /**
5996 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5997 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5998 *
5999 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that
6000 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking
6001 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot
6002 * differentiate which way it's called.
6003 *
6004 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes.
6005 *
6006 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
6007 *
6008 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued
6009 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running.
6010 */
wiphy_lock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6011 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6012 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
6013 {
6014 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
6015 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
6016 }
6017
6018 /**
6019 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
6020 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
6021 */
wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy * wiphy)6022 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6023 __releases(&wiphy->mtx)
6024 {
6025 __release(&wiphy->mtx);
6026 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
6027 }
6028
6029 struct wiphy_work;
6030 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *);
6031
6032 struct wiphy_work {
6033 struct list_head entry;
6034 wiphy_work_func_t func;
6035 };
6036
wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work * work,wiphy_work_func_t func)6037 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work,
6038 wiphy_work_func_t func)
6039 {
6040 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry);
6041 work->func = func;
6042 }
6043
6044 /**
6045 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy
6046 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6047 * @work: the work item
6048 *
6049 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6050 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6051 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6052 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6053 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6054 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6055 */
6056 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6057
6058 /**
6059 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work
6060 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6061 * @work: the work to cancel
6062 *
6063 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6064 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6065 */
6066 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6067
6068 /**
6069 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work
6070 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6071 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work
6072 *
6073 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6074 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6075 */
6076 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work);
6077
6078 struct wiphy_delayed_work {
6079 struct wiphy_work work;
6080 struct wiphy *wiphy;
6081 struct timer_list timer;
6082 };
6083
6084 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t);
6085
wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work * dwork,wiphy_work_func_t func)6086 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6087 wiphy_work_func_t func)
6088 {
6089 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0);
6090 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func);
6091 }
6092
6093 /**
6094 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy
6095 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for
6096 * @dwork: the delayable worker
6097 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6098 *
6099 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work
6100 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be
6101 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running
6102 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can
6103 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires
6104 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock().
6105 */
6106 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6107 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork,
6108 unsigned long delay);
6109
6110 /**
6111 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work
6112 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6113 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel
6114 *
6115 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being
6116 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6117 */
6118 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6119 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6120
6121 /**
6122 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work
6123 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6124 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush
6125 *
6126 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called
6127 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock().
6128 */
6129 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6130 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6131
6132 /**
6133 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending - Find out whether a wiphy delayable
6134 * work item is currently pending.
6135 *
6136 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes
6137 * @dwork: the delayed work in question
6138 *
6139 * Return: true if timer is pending, false otherwise
6140 *
6141 * How wiphy_delayed_work_queue() works is by setting a timer which
6142 * when it expires calls wiphy_work_queue() to queue the wiphy work.
6143 * Because wiphy_delayed_work_queue() uses mod_timer(), if it is
6144 * called twice and the second call happens before the first call
6145 * deadline, the work will rescheduled for the second deadline and
6146 * won't run before that.
6147 *
6148 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending() can be used to detect if calling
6149 * wiphy_work_delayed_work_queue() would start a new work schedule
6150 * or delayed a previous one. As seen below it cannot be used to
6151 * detect precisely if the work has finished to execute nor if it
6152 * is currently executing.
6153 *
6154 * CPU0 CPU1
6155 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue(wk)
6156 * mod_timer(wk->timer)
6157 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> true
6158 *
6159 * [...]
6160 * expire_timers(wk->timer)
6161 * detach_timer(wk->timer)
6162 * wiphy_delayed_work_pending(wk) -> false
6163 * wk->timer->function() |
6164 * wiphy_work_queue(wk) | delayed work pending
6165 * list_add_tail() | returns false but
6166 * queue_work(cfg80211_wiphy_work) | wk->func() has not
6167 * | been run yet
6168 * [...] |
6169 * cfg80211_wiphy_work() |
6170 * wk->func() V
6171 *
6172 */
6173 bool wiphy_delayed_work_pending(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6174 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork);
6175
6176 /**
6177 * enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power - regulatory power for an Access Point
6178 *
6179 * @IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP: Access Point has no regulatory power mode
6180 * @IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP: Indoor Access Point
6181 * @IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP: Standard power Access Point
6182 * @IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP: Very low power Access Point
6183 */
6184 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power {
6185 IEEE80211_REG_UNSET_AP,
6186 IEEE80211_REG_LPI_AP,
6187 IEEE80211_REG_SP_AP,
6188 IEEE80211_REG_VLP_AP,
6189 };
6190
6191 /**
6192 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
6193 *
6194 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
6195 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
6196 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
6197 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
6198 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
6199 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
6200 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
6201 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
6202 *
6203 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
6204 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
6205 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
6206 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
6207 *
6208 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
6209 * @iftype: interface type
6210 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
6211 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
6212 * for the notifier
6213 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
6214 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
6215 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
6216 * wireless device if it has no netdev
6217 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype
6218 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode)
6219 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
6220 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
6221 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
6222 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
6223 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
6224 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
6225 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
6226 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
6227 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
6228 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
6229 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
6230 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
6231 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
6232 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
6233 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
6234 * by cfg80211 on change_interface
6235 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
6236 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
6237 * need to propagate the update to the driver
6238 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
6239 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
6240 * the P2P Device.
6241 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
6242 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
6243 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
6244 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
6245 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
6246 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
6247 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
6248 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
6249 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
6250 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
6251 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
6252 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
6253 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
6254 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
6255 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work
6256 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
6257 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
6258 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
6259 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
6260 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
6261 * unprotected beacon report
6262 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr
6263 * @ap and @client for each link
6264 * @links.cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been
6265 * started
6266 * @links.cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was
6267 * entered.
6268 * @links.cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
6269 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid
6270 */
6271 struct wireless_dev {
6272 struct wiphy *wiphy;
6273 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
6274
6275 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
6276 struct list_head list;
6277 struct net_device *netdev;
6278
6279 u32 identifier;
6280
6281 struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
6282 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
6283
6284 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
6285
6286 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
6287
6288 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
6289 struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
6290 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
6291 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
6292 u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
6293
6294 struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
6295 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6296
6297 struct list_head event_list;
6298 spinlock_t event_lock;
6299
6300 u8 connected:1;
6301
6302 bool ps;
6303 int ps_timeout;
6304
6305 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
6306
6307 u32 owner_nlportid;
6308 bool nl_owner_dead;
6309
6310 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
6311 /* wext data */
6312 struct {
6313 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
6314 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
6315 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
6316 const u8 *ie;
6317 size_t ie_len;
6318 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6319 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
6320 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6321 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
6322 bool prev_bssid_valid;
6323 } wext;
6324 #endif
6325
6326 struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work;
6327 struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config;
6328
6329 struct list_head pmsr_list;
6330 spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
6331 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
6332
6333 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
6334
6335 union {
6336 struct {
6337 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6338 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6339 u8 ssid_len;
6340 } client;
6341 struct {
6342 int beacon_interval;
6343 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6344 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6345 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_MESH_ID_LEN];
6346 u8 id_len, id_up_len;
6347 } mesh;
6348 struct {
6349 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
6350 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6351 u8 ssid_len;
6352 } ap;
6353 struct {
6354 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6355 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6356 int beacon_interval;
6357 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
6358 u8 ssid_len;
6359 } ibss;
6360 struct {
6361 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6362 } ocb;
6363 } u;
6364
6365 struct {
6366 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
6367 union {
6368 struct {
6369 unsigned int beacon_interval;
6370 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
6371 } ap;
6372 struct {
6373 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss;
6374 } client;
6375 };
6376
6377 bool cac_started;
6378 unsigned long cac_start_time;
6379 unsigned int cac_time_ms;
6380 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
6381 u16 valid_links;
6382 };
6383
wdev_address(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6384 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6385 {
6386 if (wdev->netdev)
6387 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
6388 return wdev->address;
6389 }
6390
wdev_running(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6391 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6392 {
6393 if (wdev->netdev)
6394 return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
6395 return wdev->is_running;
6396 }
6397
6398 /**
6399 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
6400 *
6401 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
6402 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
6403 */
wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev * wdev)6404 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
6405 {
6406 BUG_ON(!wdev);
6407 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
6408 }
6409
6410 /**
6411 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev
6412 * @wdev: the wdev
6413 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO
6414 *
6415 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL.
6416 */
6417 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6418 unsigned int link_id);
6419
WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int link_id)6420 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6421 unsigned int link_id)
6422 {
6423 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links);
6424 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links &&
6425 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id)));
6426 }
6427
6428 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \
6429 for (link_id = 0; \
6430 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \
6431 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \
6432 link_id++) \
6433 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \
6434 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id)))
6435
6436 /**
6437 * DOC: Utility functions
6438 *
6439 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
6440 */
6441
6442 /**
6443 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
6444 *
6445 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
6446 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
6447 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
6448 */
6449 static inline bool
ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel * a,struct ieee80211_channel * b)6450 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
6451 struct ieee80211_channel *b)
6452 {
6453 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
6454 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
6455 }
6456
6457 /**
6458 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
6459 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
6460 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
6461 */
6462 static inline u32
ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6463 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6464 {
6465 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
6466 }
6467
6468 /**
6469 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
6470 *
6471 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
6472 * @chan: channel
6473 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
6474 */
6475 enum nl80211_chan_width
6476 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
6477
6478 /**
6479 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
6480 * @chan: channel number
6481 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6482 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6483 */
6484 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
6485
6486 /**
6487 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
6488 * @chan: channel number
6489 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
6490 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
6491 */
6492 static inline int
ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan,enum nl80211_band band)6493 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
6494 {
6495 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
6496 }
6497
6498 /**
6499 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6500 * @freq: center frequency in KHz
6501 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6502 */
6503 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
6504
6505 /**
6506 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
6507 * @freq: center frequency in MHz
6508 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
6509 */
6510 static inline int
ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)6511 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
6512 {
6513 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6514 }
6515
6516 /**
6517 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
6518 * frequency
6519 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6520 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
6521 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6522 */
6523 struct ieee80211_channel *
6524 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
6525
6526 /**
6527 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
6528 *
6529 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
6530 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
6531 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
6532 */
6533 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy * wiphy,int freq)6534 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
6535 {
6536 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
6537 }
6538
6539 /**
6540 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
6541 * @chan: control channel to check
6542 *
6543 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
6544 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
6545 *
6546 * Return: %true if channel is a PSC, %false otherwise
6547 */
cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel * chan)6548 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
6549 {
6550 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
6551 return false;
6552
6553 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
6554 }
6555
6556 /**
6557 * cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid - Check if the radio supports the chandef
6558 *
6559 * @radio: wiphy radio
6560 * @chandef: chandef for current channel
6561 *
6562 * Return: whether or not the given chandef is valid for the given radio
6563 */
6564 bool cfg80211_radio_chandef_valid(const struct wiphy_radio *radio,
6565 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
6566
6567 /**
6568 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
6569 *
6570 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6571 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
6572 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
6573 *
6574 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
6575 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
6576 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
6577 * rates in the band's bitrate table.
6578 */
6579 const struct ieee80211_rate *
6580 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6581 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
6582
6583 /**
6584 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
6585 * @sband: the band to look for rates in
6586 *
6587 * Return: a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given band, bits
6588 * are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
6589 */
6590 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband);
6591
6592 /*
6593 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
6594 *
6595 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
6596 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
6597 */
6598
6599 struct radiotap_align_size {
6600 uint8_t align:4, size:4;
6601 };
6602
6603 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
6604 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
6605 int n_bits;
6606 uint32_t oui;
6607 uint8_t subns;
6608 };
6609
6610 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
6611 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
6612 int n_ns;
6613 };
6614
6615 /**
6616 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
6617 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
6618 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
6619 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
6620 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
6621 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
6622 * the beginning of the actual data portion
6623 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
6624 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
6625 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
6626 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
6627 * radiotap namespace or not
6628 *
6629 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
6630 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
6631 * @_arg_index: next argument index
6632 * @_arg: next argument pointer
6633 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
6634 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
6635 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
6636 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
6637 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
6638 * next bitmap word
6639 *
6640 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
6641 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
6642 */
6643
6644 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
6645 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
6646 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
6647 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
6648
6649 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
6650 __le32 *_next_bitmap;
6651
6652 unsigned char *this_arg;
6653 int this_arg_index;
6654 int this_arg_size;
6655
6656 int is_radiotap_ns;
6657
6658 int _max_length;
6659 int _arg_index;
6660 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
6661 int _reset_on_ext;
6662 };
6663
6664 int
6665 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
6666 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
6667 int max_length,
6668 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
6669
6670 int
6671 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
6672
6673
6674 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
6675 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
6676
6677 /**
6678 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
6679 *
6680 * @skb: the frame
6681 *
6682 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
6683 * returns the 802.11 header length.
6684 *
6685 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
6686 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
6687 * 802.11 header.
6688 */
6689 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
6690
6691 /**
6692 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
6693 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
6694 * Return: The header length in bytes.
6695 */
6696 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
6697
6698 /**
6699 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
6700 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
6701 * (first byte) will be accessed
6702 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
6703 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
6704 */
6705 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
6706
6707 /**
6708 * DOC: Data path helpers
6709 *
6710 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
6711 * functions that help implement the data path for devices
6712 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
6713 */
6714
6715 /**
6716 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6717 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6718 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
6719 * of it being pushed into the SKB
6720 * @addr: the device MAC address
6721 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6722 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
6723 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU
6724 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6725 */
6726 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
6727 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6728 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
6729
6730 /**
6731 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
6732 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
6733 * @addr: the device MAC address
6734 * @iftype: the virtual interface type
6735 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6736 */
ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff * skb,const u8 * addr,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)6737 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
6738 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
6739 {
6740 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
6741 }
6742
6743 /**
6744 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid
6745 *
6746 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated
6747 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the
6748 * mesh control field.
6749 *
6750 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6751 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test
6752 * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field
6753 * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6754 * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field
6755 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode
6756 */
6757 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr);
6758
6759 /**
6760 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
6761 *
6762 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
6763 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
6764 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
6765 *
6766 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
6767 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
6768 * initialized by the caller.
6769 * @addr: The device MAC address.
6770 * @iftype: The device interface type.
6771 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
6772 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6773 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
6774 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu
6775 */
6776 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
6777 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
6778 const unsigned int extra_headroom,
6779 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa,
6780 u8 mesh_control);
6781
6782 /**
6783 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol
6784 *
6785 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated
6786 * protocol.
6787 *
6788 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload
6789 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol
6790 * Return: true if encapsulation was found
6791 */
6792 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto);
6793
6794 /**
6795 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames
6796 *
6797 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part
6798 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh
6799 * header to the ethernet header (if present).
6800 *
6801 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header
6802 *
6803 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
6804 */
6805 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb);
6806
6807 /**
6808 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
6809 * @skb: the data frame
6810 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
6811 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
6812 */
6813 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
6814 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
6815
6816 /**
6817 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
6818 *
6819 * @eid: element ID
6820 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6821 * @len: length of data
6822 * @match: byte array to match
6823 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6824 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
6825 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
6826 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
6827 * the data portion instead.
6828 *
6829 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6830 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6831 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6832 * requested element struct.
6833 *
6834 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6835 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6836 * byte array to match.
6837 */
6838 const struct element *
6839 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6840 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6841 unsigned int match_offset);
6842
6843 /**
6844 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
6845 *
6846 * @eid: element ID
6847 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6848 * @len: length of data
6849 * @match: byte array to match
6850 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
6851 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
6852 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
6853 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
6854 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
6855 * the second byte is the IE length.
6856 *
6857 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6858 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6859 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
6860 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6861 * element ID.
6862 *
6863 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6864 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
6865 * byte array to match.
6866 */
6867 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len,const u8 * match,unsigned int match_len,unsigned int match_offset)6868 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
6869 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
6870 unsigned int match_offset)
6871 {
6872 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
6873 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
6874 */
6875 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
6876 (!match_len && match_offset)))
6877 return NULL;
6878
6879 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
6880 match, match_len,
6881 match_offset ?
6882 match_offset - 2 : 0);
6883 }
6884
6885 /**
6886 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
6887 *
6888 * @eid: element ID
6889 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6890 * @len: length of data
6891 *
6892 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6893 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6894 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6895 * requested element struct.
6896 *
6897 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6898 * having to fit into the given data.
6899 */
6900 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6901 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6902 {
6903 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6904 }
6905
6906 /**
6907 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
6908 *
6909 * @eid: element ID
6910 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6911 * @len: length of data
6912 *
6913 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
6914 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6915 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6916 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6917 *
6918 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6919 * having to fit into the given data.
6920 */
cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6921 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6922 {
6923 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
6924 }
6925
6926 /**
6927 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
6928 *
6929 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6930 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6931 * @len: length of data
6932 *
6933 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if
6934 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6935 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
6936 * requested element struct.
6937 *
6938 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6939 * having to fit into the given data.
6940 */
6941 static inline const struct element *
cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6942 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6943 {
6944 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6945 &ext_eid, 1, 0);
6946 }
6947
6948 /**
6949 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
6950 *
6951 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
6952 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6953 * @len: length of data
6954 *
6955 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
6956 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
6957 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
6958 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
6959 *
6960 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
6961 * having to fit into the given data.
6962 */
cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid,const u8 * ies,int len)6963 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
6964 {
6965 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
6966 &ext_eid, 1, 2);
6967 }
6968
6969 /**
6970 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
6971 *
6972 * @oui: vendor OUI
6973 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6974 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6975 * @len: length of data
6976 *
6977 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6978 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
6979 * return the element structure for the requested element.
6980 *
6981 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6982 * the given data.
6983 */
6984 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6985 const u8 *ies,
6986 unsigned int len);
6987
6988 /**
6989 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
6990 *
6991 * @oui: vendor OUI
6992 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
6993 * @ies: data consisting of IEs
6994 * @len: length of data
6995 *
6996 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6997 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6998 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6999 * element ID.
7000 *
7001 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
7002 * the given data.
7003 */
7004 static inline const u8 *
cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui,int oui_type,const u8 * ies,unsigned int len)7005 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
7006 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
7007 {
7008 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
7009 }
7010
7011 /**
7012 * enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret - reduced neighbor report iteration state
7013 * @RNR_ITER_CONTINUE: continue iterating with the next entry
7014 * @RNR_ITER_BREAK: break iteration and return success
7015 * @RNR_ITER_ERROR: break iteration and return error
7016 */
7017 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret {
7018 RNR_ITER_CONTINUE,
7019 RNR_ITER_BREAK,
7020 RNR_ITER_ERROR,
7021 };
7022
7023 /**
7024 * cfg80211_iter_rnr - iterate reduced neighbor report entries
7025 * @elems: the frame elements to iterate RNR elements and then
7026 * their entries in
7027 * @elems_len: length of the elements
7028 * @iter: iteration function, see also &enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7029 * for the return value
7030 * @iter_data: additional data passed to the iteration function
7031 * Return: %true on success (after successfully iterating all entries
7032 * or if the iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_BREAK),
7033 * %false on error (iteration function returned %RNR_ITER_ERROR
7034 * or elements were malformed.)
7035 */
7036 bool cfg80211_iter_rnr(const u8 *elems, size_t elems_len,
7037 enum cfg80211_rnr_iter_ret
7038 (*iter)(void *data, u8 type,
7039 const struct ieee80211_neighbor_ap_info *info,
7040 const u8 *tbtt_info, u8 tbtt_info_len),
7041 void *iter_data);
7042
7043 /**
7044 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer
7045 *
7046 * @elem: the element to defragment
7047 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained
7048 * @ieslen: length of @ies
7049 * @data: buffer to store element data, or %NULL to just determine size
7050 * @data_len: length of @data, or 0
7051 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments
7052 *
7053 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error
7054 *
7055 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while
7056 * skipping all headers.
7057 *
7058 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an
7059 * element in-place.
7060 */
7061 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies,
7062 size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len,
7063 u8 frag_id);
7064
7065 /**
7066 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
7067 *
7068 * @dev: network device
7069 * @addr: STA MAC address
7070 *
7071 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
7072 * devices upon STA association.
7073 */
7074 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7075
7076 /**
7077 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
7078 *
7079 * TODO
7080 */
7081
7082 /**
7083 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
7084 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
7085 * conflicts)
7086 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
7087 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
7088 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
7089 * alpha2.
7090 *
7091 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
7092 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
7093 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
7094 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
7095 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
7096 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
7097 *
7098 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
7099 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
7100 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
7101 *
7102 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7103 * an -ENOMEM.
7104 *
7105 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
7106 */
7107 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
7108
7109 /**
7110 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
7111 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7112 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7113 *
7114 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
7115 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
7116 * information.
7117 *
7118 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7119 */
7120 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7121 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7122
7123 /**
7124 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
7125 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7126 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
7127 *
7128 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
7129 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
7130 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
7131 *
7132 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
7133 */
7134 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7135 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
7136
7137 /**
7138 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
7139 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
7140 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
7141 *
7142 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
7143 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
7144 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
7145 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
7146 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
7147 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
7148 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
7149 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
7150 * that called this helper.
7151 */
7152 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7153 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
7154
7155 /**
7156 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
7157 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
7158 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
7159 *
7160 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
7161 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
7162 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
7163 * and processed already.
7164 *
7165 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
7166 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
7167 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
7168 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
7169 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
7170 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
7171 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
7172 */
7173 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7174 u32 center_freq);
7175
7176 /**
7177 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
7178 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
7179 *
7180 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
7181 * proper string representation.
7182 *
7183 * Return: pointer to string representation of the initiator
7184 */
7185 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
7186
7187 /**
7188 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
7189 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
7190 *
7191 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
7192 *
7193 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
7194 */
7195 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7196
7197 /**
7198 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
7199 *
7200 */
7201
7202 /**
7203 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
7204 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
7205 *
7206 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
7207 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried.
7208 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
7209 *
7210 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query
7211 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
7212 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
7213 *
7214 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
7215 * an -ENODATA.
7216 *
7217 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
7218 */
7219 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
7220 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
7221
7222 /*
7223 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
7224 * functions and BSS handling helpers
7225 */
7226
7227 /**
7228 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
7229 *
7230 * @request: the corresponding scan request
7231 * @info: information about the completed scan
7232 */
7233 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
7234 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
7235
7236 /**
7237 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
7238 *
7239 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
7240 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7241 */
7242 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7243
7244 /**
7245 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7246 *
7247 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7248 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7249 *
7250 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7251 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
7252 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7253 */
7254 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7255
7256 /**
7257 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
7258 *
7259 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
7260 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
7261 *
7262 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
7263 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver
7264 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
7265 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
7266 */
7267 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
7268
7269 /**
7270 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
7271 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7272 * @data: the BSS metadata
7273 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
7274 * @len: length of the management frame
7275 * @gfp: context flags
7276 *
7277 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7278 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7279 *
7280 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7281 * Or %NULL on error.
7282 */
7283 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7284 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7285 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7286 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7287 gfp_t gfp);
7288
7289 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,struct ieee80211_mgmt * mgmt,size_t len,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7290 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7291 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7292 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
7293 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7294 {
7295 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7296 .chan = rx_channel,
7297 .signal = signal,
7298 };
7299
7300 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
7301 }
7302
7303 /**
7304 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
7305 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
7306 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
7307 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
7308 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
7309 */
cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 * bssid,u8 max_bssid,u8 mbssid_index,u8 * new_bssid)7310 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
7311 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
7312 {
7313 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
7314 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
7315 u64 new_bssid_u64;
7316
7317 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
7318
7319 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
7320
7321 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
7322 }
7323
7324 /**
7325 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
7326 * @element: element to check
7327 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
7328 *
7329 * Return: %true if should be inherited, %false otherwise
7330 */
7331 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
7332 const struct element *non_inherit_element);
7333
7334 /**
7335 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
7336 * @ie: ies
7337 * @ielen: length of IEs
7338 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
7339 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
7340 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
7341 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
7342 *
7343 * Return: the number of bytes merged
7344 */
7345 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7346 const struct element *mbssid_elem,
7347 const struct element *sub_elem,
7348 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
7349
7350 /**
7351 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
7352 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
7353 * from a beacon or probe response
7354 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
7355 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
7356 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON: data comes from an S1G beacon
7357 */
7358 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
7359 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
7360 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
7361 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
7362 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_S1G_BEACON,
7363 };
7364
7365 /**
7366 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies
7367 * @ie: IEs
7368 * @ielen: length of IEs
7369 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel
7370 *
7371 * Return: the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined.
7372 */
7373 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7374 enum nl80211_band band);
7375
7376 /**
7377 * cfg80211_ssid_eq - compare two SSIDs
7378 * @a: first SSID
7379 * @b: second SSID
7380 *
7381 * Return: %true if SSIDs are equal, %false otherwise.
7382 */
7383 static inline bool
cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid * a,struct cfg80211_ssid * b)7384 cfg80211_ssid_eq(struct cfg80211_ssid *a, struct cfg80211_ssid *b)
7385 {
7386 if (WARN_ON(!a || !b))
7387 return false;
7388 if (a->ssid_len != b->ssid_len)
7389 return false;
7390 return memcmp(a->ssid, b->ssid, a->ssid_len) ? false : true;
7391 }
7392
7393 /**
7394 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
7395 *
7396 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
7397 * @data: the BSS metadata
7398 * @ftype: frame type (if known)
7399 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
7400 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
7401 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
7402 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
7403 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
7404 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
7405 * @gfp: context flags
7406 *
7407 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
7408 * the BSS should be updated/added.
7409 *
7410 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
7411 * Or %NULL on error.
7412 */
7413 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
7414 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7415 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
7416 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7417 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7418 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7419 gfp_t gfp);
7420
7421 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * rx_channel,enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,const u8 * bssid,u64 tsf,u16 capability,u16 beacon_interval,const u8 * ie,size_t ielen,s32 signal,gfp_t gfp)7422 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7423 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
7424 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
7425 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
7426 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
7427 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
7428 {
7429 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
7430 .chan = rx_channel,
7431 .signal = signal,
7432 };
7433
7434 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
7435 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
7436 gfp);
7437 }
7438
7439 /**
7440 * __cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7441 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7442 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7443 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7444 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7445 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7446 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7447 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7448 * @use_for: indicates which use is intended
7449 *
7450 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7451 */
7452 struct cfg80211_bss *__cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7453 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7454 const u8 *bssid,
7455 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7456 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7457 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy,
7458 u32 use_for);
7459
7460 /**
7461 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
7462 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7463 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
7464 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
7465 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
7466 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
7467 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
7468 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
7469 *
7470 * This version implies regular usage, %NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL.
7471 *
7472 * Return: Reference-counted BSS on success. %NULL on error.
7473 */
7474 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len,enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)7475 cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7476 const u8 *bssid, const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
7477 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
7478 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy)
7479 {
7480 return __cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, bssid, ssid, ssid_len,
7481 bss_type, privacy,
7482 NL80211_BSS_USE_FOR_NORMAL);
7483 }
7484
7485 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct ieee80211_channel * channel,const u8 * ssid,size_t ssid_len)7486 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7487 struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
7488 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
7489 {
7490 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
7491 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
7492 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
7493 }
7494
7495 /**
7496 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
7497 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7498 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
7499 *
7500 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7501 */
7502 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7503
7504 /**
7505 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
7506 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
7507 * @bss: the BSS struct
7508 *
7509 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
7510 */
7511 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7512
7513 /**
7514 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
7515 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7516 * @bss: the bss to remove
7517 *
7518 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
7519 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
7520 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
7521 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
7522 */
7523 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
7524
7525 /**
7526 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
7527 *
7528 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
7529 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
7530 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
7531 *
7532 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7533 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
7534 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
7535 * @iter: the iterator function to call
7536 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
7537 */
7538 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7539 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7540 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7541 struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
7542 void *data),
7543 void *iter_data);
7544
7545 /**
7546 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
7547 * @dev: network device
7548 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
7549 * @len: length of the frame data
7550 *
7551 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
7552 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
7553 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
7554 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7555 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7556 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7557 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
7558 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
7559 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
7560 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
7561 *
7562 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7563 */
7564 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7565
7566 /**
7567 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
7568 * @dev: network device
7569 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
7570 *
7571 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
7572 * mutex.
7573 */
7574 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
7575
7576 /**
7577 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data
7578 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
7579 * @len: length of the frame data
7580 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
7581 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
7582 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
7583 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
7584 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO)
7585 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for
7586 * non-MLO connections
7587 * @links.bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the
7588 * pointer moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp()
7589 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that
7590 * were rejected by the AP.
7591 */
7592 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data {
7593 const u8 *buf;
7594 size_t len;
7595 const u8 *req_ies;
7596 size_t req_ies_len;
7597 int uapsd_queues;
7598 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7599 struct {
7600 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
7601 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7602 u16 status;
7603 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7604 };
7605
7606 /**
7607 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
7608 * @dev: network device
7609 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data
7610 *
7611 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
7612 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
7613 *
7614 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7615 */
7616 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
7617 const struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data);
7618
7619 /**
7620 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data
7621 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL
7622 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections
7623 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL)
7624 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise
7625 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some
7626 * other API (e.g. deauth RX)
7627 */
7628 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure {
7629 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
7630 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
7631 bool timeout;
7632 };
7633
7634 /**
7635 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure
7636 * @dev: network device
7637 * @data: data describing the association failure
7638 *
7639 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
7640 */
7641 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev,
7642 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data);
7643
7644 /**
7645 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
7646 * @dev: network device
7647 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
7648 * @len: length of the frame data
7649 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
7650 *
7651 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
7652 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
7653 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
7654 * corresponding wdev's mutex.
7655 */
7656 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7657 bool reconnect);
7658
7659 /**
7660 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
7661 * @dev: network device
7662 * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
7663 * @len: length of the frame data
7664 *
7665 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
7666 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
7667 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
7668 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
7669 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
7670 *
7671 * This function may sleep.
7672 */
7673 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
7674 const u8 *buf, size_t len);
7675
7676 /**
7677 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
7678 * @dev: network device
7679 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
7680 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
7681 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
7682 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
7683 * @gfp: allocation flags
7684 *
7685 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
7686 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
7687 * primitive.
7688 */
7689 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7690 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
7691 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
7692
7693 /**
7694 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
7695 *
7696 * @dev: network device
7697 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
7698 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
7699 * @gfp: allocation flags
7700 *
7701 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
7702 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
7703 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
7704 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
7705 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
7706 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
7707 */
7708 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7709 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
7710
7711 /**
7712 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
7713 * candidate
7714 *
7715 * @dev: network device
7716 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
7717 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
7718 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
7719 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm
7720 * @gfp: allocation flags
7721 *
7722 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
7723 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
7724 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
7725 */
7726 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
7727 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
7728 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
7729
7730 /**
7731 * DOC: RFkill integration
7732 *
7733 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
7734 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
7735 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
7736 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off. Drivers are
7737 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
7738 *
7739 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
7740 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
7741 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
7742 */
7743
7744 /**
7745 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
7746 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7747 * @blocked: block status
7748 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
7749 */
7750 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
7751 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
7752
wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy * wiphy,bool blocked)7753 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
7754 {
7755 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
7756 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
7757 }
7758
7759 /**
7760 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
7761 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7762 */
7763 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7764
7765 /**
7766 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
7767 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7768 */
wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy * wiphy)7769 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
7770 {
7771 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
7772 }
7773
7774 /**
7775 * DOC: Vendor commands
7776 *
7777 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
7778 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
7779 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
7780 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
7781 * the configuration mechanism.
7782 *
7783 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
7784 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one. Each command has an
7785 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
7786 *
7787 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
7788 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
7789 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
7790 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
7791 * managers etc. need.
7792 */
7793
7794 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7795 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7796 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7797 int approxlen);
7798
7799 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7800 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7801 enum nl80211_commands cmd,
7802 enum nl80211_attrs attr,
7803 unsigned int portid,
7804 int vendor_event_idx,
7805 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
7806
7807 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
7808
7809 /**
7810 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
7811 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7812 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7813 * be put into the skb
7814 *
7815 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7816 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7817 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
7818 *
7819 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
7820 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7821 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7822 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7823 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7824 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
7825 * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
7826 *
7827 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
7828 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
7829 *
7830 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7831 */
7832 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7833 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7834 {
7835 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7836 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
7837 }
7838
7839 /**
7840 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
7841 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7842 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
7843 *
7844 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7845 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
7846 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the
7847 * skb regardless of the return value.
7848 *
7849 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7850 */
7851 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
7852
7853 /**
7854 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
7855 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7856 *
7857 * Return: the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
7858 *
7859 * Context: May only be called from a vendor command handler
7860 */
7861 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7862
7863 /**
7864 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
7865 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7866 * @wdev: the wireless device
7867 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7868 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7869 * be put into the skb
7870 * @gfp: allocation flags
7871 *
7872 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
7873 * vendor-specific multicast group.
7874 *
7875 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7876 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7877 * attribute.
7878 *
7879 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7880 * skb to send the event.
7881 *
7882 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7883 */
7884 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7885 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7886 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7887 {
7888 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7889 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7890 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7891 }
7892
7893 /**
7894 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
7895 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7896 * @wdev: the wireless device
7897 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
7898 * @portid: port ID of the receiver
7899 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7900 * be put into the skb
7901 * @gfp: allocation flags
7902 *
7903 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
7904 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
7905 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
7906 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
7907 *
7908 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
7909 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
7910 * attribute.
7911 *
7912 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
7913 * skb to send the event.
7914 *
7915 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7916 */
7917 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct wireless_dev * wdev,unsigned int portid,int approxlen,int event_idx,gfp_t gfp)7918 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7919 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7920 unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
7921 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
7922 {
7923 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
7924 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
7925 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
7926 }
7927
7928 /**
7929 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
7930 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
7931 * @gfp: allocation flags
7932 *
7933 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
7934 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
7935 */
cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)7936 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
7937 {
7938 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
7939 }
7940
7941 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
7942 /**
7943 * DOC: Test mode
7944 *
7945 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
7946 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
7947 * factory programming.
7948 *
7949 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it. For more
7950 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
7951 */
7952
7953 /**
7954 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
7955 * @wiphy: the wiphy
7956 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
7957 * be put into the skb
7958 *
7959 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
7960 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
7961 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
7962 *
7963 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
7964 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
7965 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
7966 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
7967 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
7968 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
7969 * must not modify the skb in any other way.
7970 *
7971 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
7972 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
7973 *
7974 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
7975 */
7976 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen)7977 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
7978 {
7979 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
7980 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
7981 }
7982
7983 /**
7984 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
7985 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
7986 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
7987 *
7988 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
7989 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
7990 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb
7991 * regardless of the return value.
7992 *
7993 * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
7994 */
cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff * skb)7995 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
7996 {
7997 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
7998 }
7999
8000 /**
8001 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
8002 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8003 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
8004 * be put into the skb
8005 * @gfp: allocation flags
8006 *
8007 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
8008 * testmode multicast group.
8009 *
8010 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
8011 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
8012 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
8013 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
8014 * in any other way.
8015 *
8016 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
8017 * skb to send the event.
8018 *
8019 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
8020 */
8021 static inline struct sk_buff *
cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy * wiphy,int approxlen,gfp_t gfp)8022 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
8023 {
8024 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
8025 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
8026 approxlen, gfp);
8027 }
8028
8029 /**
8030 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
8031 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
8032 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
8033 * @gfp: allocation flags
8034 *
8035 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
8036 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
8037 * consumes it.
8038 */
cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff * skb,gfp_t gfp)8039 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
8040 {
8041 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
8042 }
8043
8044 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd),
8045 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd),
8046 #else
8047 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
8048 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
8049 #endif
8050
8051 /**
8052 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
8053 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
8054 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
8055 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
8056 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid.
8057 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
8058 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
8059 * status for a FILS connection.
8060 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8061 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
8062 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
8063 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
8064 */
8065 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
8066 const u8 *kek;
8067 size_t kek_len;
8068 bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
8069 u16 erp_next_seq_num;
8070 const u8 *pmk;
8071 size_t pmk_len;
8072 const u8 *pmkid;
8073 };
8074
8075 /**
8076 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
8077 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8078 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8079 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8080 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8081 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8082 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8083 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8084 * case.
8085 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
8086 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
8087 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8088 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
8089 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
8090 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8091 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8092 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8093 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8094 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8095 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8096 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise
8097 * zero.
8098 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8099 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated
8100 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the
8101 * connected AP info.
8102 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise
8103 * %NULL.
8104 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO
8105 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL).
8106 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected.
8107 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA
8108 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be
8109 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and
8110 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning
8111 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers
8112 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs
8113 * to be specified.
8114 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not
8115 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the
8116 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released)
8117 */
8118 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
8119 int status;
8120 const u8 *req_ie;
8121 size_t req_ie_len;
8122 const u8 *resp_ie;
8123 size_t resp_ie_len;
8124 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8125 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
8126
8127 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8128 u16 valid_links;
8129 struct {
8130 const u8 *addr;
8131 const u8 *bssid;
8132 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8133 u16 status;
8134 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8135 };
8136
8137 /**
8138 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8139 *
8140 * @dev: network device
8141 * @params: connection response parameters
8142 * @gfp: allocation flags
8143 *
8144 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8145 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8146 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
8147 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
8148 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
8149 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8150 */
8151 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
8152 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
8153 gfp_t gfp);
8154
8155 /**
8156 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8157 *
8158 * @dev: network device
8159 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8160 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
8161 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
8162 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
8163 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
8164 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
8165 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
8166 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8167 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8168 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8169 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8170 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8171 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8172 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
8173 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
8174 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
8175 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
8176 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
8177 * case.
8178 * @gfp: allocation flags
8179 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
8180 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
8181 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
8182 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
8183 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
8184 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
8185 *
8186 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8187 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8188 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
8189 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
8190 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8191 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8192 */
8193 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,struct cfg80211_bss * bss,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,int status,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8194 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8195 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
8196 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
8197 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
8198 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8199 {
8200 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
8201
8202 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params));
8203 params.status = status;
8204 params.links[0].bssid = bssid;
8205 params.links[0].bss = bss;
8206 params.req_ie = req_ie;
8207 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
8208 params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
8209 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
8210 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
8211
8212 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp);
8213 }
8214
8215 /**
8216 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
8217 *
8218 * @dev: network device
8219 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8220 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8221 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8222 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8223 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8224 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
8225 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
8226 * the real status code for failures.
8227 * @gfp: allocation flags
8228 *
8229 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
8230 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
8231 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
8232 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8233 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8234 */
8235 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,const u8 * resp_ie,size_t resp_ie_len,u16 status,gfp_t gfp)8236 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8237 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
8238 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
8239 u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
8240 {
8241 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
8242 resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
8243 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
8244 }
8245
8246 /**
8247 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
8248 *
8249 * @dev: network device
8250 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
8251 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8252 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8253 * @gfp: allocation flags
8254 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
8255 *
8256 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
8257 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
8258 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
8259 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
8260 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
8261 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
8262 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
8263 */
8264 static inline void
cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * bssid,const u8 * req_ie,size_t req_ie_len,gfp_t gfp,enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)8265 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8266 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
8267 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
8268 {
8269 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
8270 gfp, timeout_reason);
8271 }
8272
8273 /**
8274 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
8275 *
8276 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
8277 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
8278 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
8279 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
8280 * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
8281 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set.
8282 * Otherwise zero.
8283 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL.
8284 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in
8285 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info.
8286 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL.
8287 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO
8288 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be
8289 * %NULL if %links.bss is set.
8290 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP.
8291 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got
8292 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to
8293 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set)
8294 */
8295 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
8296 const u8 *req_ie;
8297 size_t req_ie_len;
8298 const u8 *resp_ie;
8299 size_t resp_ie_len;
8300 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
8301
8302 const u8 *ap_mld_addr;
8303 u16 valid_links;
8304 struct {
8305 const u8 *addr;
8306 const u8 *bssid;
8307 struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
8308 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
8309 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
8310 };
8311
8312 /**
8313 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
8314 *
8315 * @dev: network device
8316 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
8317 * @gfp: allocation flags
8318 *
8319 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
8320 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
8321 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
8322 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
8323 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
8324 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
8325 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
8326 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
8327 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
8328 * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
8329 */
8330 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
8331 gfp_t gfp);
8332
8333 /**
8334 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
8335 *
8336 * @dev: network device
8337 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address
8338 * in case of AP/P2P GO
8339 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy
8340 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy
8341 * @gfp: allocation flags
8342 *
8343 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
8344 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
8345 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
8346 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
8347 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
8348 * indicate the 802.11 association.
8349 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports
8350 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of
8351 * associated STA/GC.
8352 */
8353 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr,
8354 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp);
8355
8356 /**
8357 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
8358 *
8359 * @dev: network device
8360 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
8361 * @ie_len: length of IEs
8362 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
8363 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
8364 * @gfp: allocation flags
8365 *
8366 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
8367 * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
8368 */
8369 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
8370 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
8371 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
8372
8373 /**
8374 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
8375 * @wdev: wireless device
8376 * @cookie: the request cookie
8377 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8378 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
8379 * channel
8380 * @gfp: allocation flags
8381 */
8382 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8383 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8384 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
8385
8386 /**
8387 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
8388 * @wdev: wireless device
8389 * @cookie: the request cookie
8390 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
8391 * @gfp: allocation flags
8392 */
8393 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8394 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
8395 gfp_t gfp);
8396
8397 /**
8398 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
8399 * @wdev: wireless device
8400 * @cookie: the requested cookie
8401 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
8402 * @gfp: allocation flags
8403 */
8404 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8405 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
8406
8407 /**
8408 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
8409 *
8410 * @sinfo: the station information
8411 * @gfp: allocation flags
8412 *
8413 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
8414 */
8415 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8416
8417 /**
8418 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
8419 * @sinfo: the station information
8420 *
8421 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
8422 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
8423 * the stack.)
8424 */
cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info * sinfo)8425 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
8426 {
8427 kfree(sinfo->pertid);
8428 }
8429
8430 /**
8431 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
8432 *
8433 * @dev: the netdev
8434 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8435 * @sinfo: the station information
8436 * @gfp: allocation flags
8437 */
8438 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8439 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8440
8441 /**
8442 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8443 * @dev: the netdev
8444 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8445 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
8446 * @gfp: allocation flags
8447 */
8448 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8449 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
8450
8451 /**
8452 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
8453 *
8454 * @dev: the netdev
8455 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used.
8456 * @gfp: allocation flags
8457 */
cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device * dev,const u8 * mac_addr,gfp_t gfp)8458 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
8459 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
8460 {
8461 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
8462 }
8463
8464 /**
8465 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
8466 *
8467 * @dev: the netdev
8468 * @mac_addr: the station's address
8469 * @reason: the reason for connection failure
8470 * @gfp: allocation flags
8471 *
8472 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
8473 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
8474 * for some reasons, this function is called.
8475 *
8476 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
8477 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
8478 */
8479 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
8480 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
8481 gfp_t gfp);
8482
8483 /**
8484 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info
8485 *
8486 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz
8487 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8488 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of
8489 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid
8490 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on
8491 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8492 * @len: length of the frame data
8493 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8494 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds
8495 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds
8496 */
8497 struct cfg80211_rx_info {
8498 int freq;
8499 int sig_dbm;
8500 bool have_link_id;
8501 u8 link_id;
8502 const u8 *buf;
8503 size_t len;
8504 u32 flags;
8505 u64 rx_tstamp;
8506 u64 ack_tstamp;
8507 };
8508
8509 /**
8510 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info
8511 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8512 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info
8513 *
8514 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8515 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8516 *
8517 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8518 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8519 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8520 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8521 */
8522 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8523 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info);
8524
8525 /**
8526 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8527 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8528 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
8529 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8530 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8531 * @len: length of the frame data
8532 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8533 *
8534 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8535 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8536 *
8537 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8538 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8539 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8540 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8541 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8542 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8543 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8544 u32 flags)
8545 {
8546 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8547 .freq = freq,
8548 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8549 .buf = buf,
8550 .len = len,
8551 .flags = flags
8552 };
8553
8554 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8555 }
8556
8557 /**
8558 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
8559 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8560 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
8561 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8562 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8563 * @len: length of the frame data
8564 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
8565 *
8566 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
8567 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
8568 *
8569 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
8570 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
8571 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
8572 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
8573 */
cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev * wdev,int freq,int sig_dbm,const u8 * buf,size_t len,u32 flags)8574 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
8575 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
8576 u32 flags)
8577 {
8578 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = {
8579 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8580 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm,
8581 .buf = buf,
8582 .len = len,
8583 .flags = flags
8584 };
8585
8586 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info);
8587 }
8588
8589 /**
8590 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information
8591 *
8592 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8593 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds
8594 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds
8595 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8596 * @len: length of the frame data
8597 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8598 */
8599 struct cfg80211_tx_status {
8600 u64 cookie;
8601 u64 tx_tstamp;
8602 u64 ack_tstamp;
8603 const u8 *buf;
8604 size_t len;
8605 bool ack;
8606 };
8607
8608 /**
8609 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info
8610 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8611 * @status: TX status data
8612 * @gfp: context flags
8613 *
8614 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8615 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8616 * transmission attempt with extended info.
8617 */
8618 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8619 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp);
8620
8621 /**
8622 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
8623 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8624 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
8625 * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
8626 * @len: length of the frame data
8627 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8628 * @gfp: context flags
8629 *
8630 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
8631 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
8632 * transmission attempt.
8633 */
cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev * wdev,u64 cookie,const u8 * buf,size_t len,bool ack,gfp_t gfp)8634 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8635 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf,
8636 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp)
8637 {
8638 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = {
8639 .cookie = cookie,
8640 .buf = buf,
8641 .len = len,
8642 .ack = ack
8643 };
8644
8645 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp);
8646 }
8647
8648 /**
8649 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
8650 * port frames
8651 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
8652 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
8653 * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
8654 * @len: length of the frame data
8655 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
8656 * @gfp: context flags
8657 *
8658 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
8659 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
8660 * the transmission attempt.
8661 */
8662 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
8663 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
8664 gfp_t gfp);
8665
8666 /**
8667 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
8668 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8669 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf
8670 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear.
8671 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
8672 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that
8673 * skb->protocol is set appropriately.
8674 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
8675 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown
8676 *
8677 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
8678 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
8679 * control port frames over nl80211.
8680 *
8681 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
8682 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
8683 *
8684 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
8685 */
8686 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb,
8687 bool unencrypted, int link_id);
8688
8689 /**
8690 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
8691 * @dev: network device
8692 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
8693 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
8694 * @gfp: context flags
8695 *
8696 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
8697 * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
8698 */
8699 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8700 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
8701 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
8702
8703 /**
8704 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
8705 * @dev: network device
8706 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8707 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
8708 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
8709 * threshold (to account for temporary interference)
8710 * @gfp: context flags
8711 */
8712 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8713 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
8714
8715 /**
8716 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
8717 * @dev: network device
8718 * @peer: peer's MAC address
8719 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
8720 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
8721 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
8722 * @gfp: context flags
8723 *
8724 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
8725 * given interval is exceeded.
8726 */
8727 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
8728 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
8729
8730 /**
8731 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
8732 * @dev: network device
8733 * @gfp: context flags
8734 *
8735 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
8736 */
8737 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
8738
8739 /**
8740 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
8741 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8742 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8743 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain
8744 * @gfp: context flags
8745 *
8746 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
8747 */
8748 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8749 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8750 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp);
8751
8752 static inline void
cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8753 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8754 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8755 gfp_t gfp)
8756 {
8757 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp);
8758 }
8759
8760 static inline void
cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,gfp_t gfp)8761 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8762 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8763 gfp_t gfp)
8764 {
8765 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp);
8766 }
8767
8768 /**
8769 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
8770 * @dev: network device
8771 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
8772 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
8773 * @gfp: context flags
8774 *
8775 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
8776 * frame.
8777 */
8778 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
8779 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
8780 gfp_t gfp);
8781
8782 /**
8783 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
8784 * @netdev: network device
8785 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
8786 * @event: type of event
8787 * @gfp: context flags
8788 * @link_id: valid link_id for MLO operation or 0 otherwise.
8789 *
8790 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
8791 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
8792 * also by full-MAC drivers.
8793 */
8794 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8795 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8796 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp,
8797 unsigned int link_id);
8798
8799 /**
8800 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event
8801 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8802 *
8803 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check
8804 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain.
8805 */
8806 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8807
8808 /**
8809 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
8810 * @dev: network device
8811 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
8812 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
8813 * @gfp: allocation flags
8814 */
8815 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
8816 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
8817
8818 /**
8819 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
8820 * @dev: network device
8821 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
8822 * @bssid: BSSID of AP
8823 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
8824 * @gfp: allocation flags
8825 */
8826 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
8827 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
8828
8829 /**
8830 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
8831 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8832 * @addr: the transmitter address
8833 * @gfp: context flags
8834 *
8835 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8836 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
8837 * sender.
8838 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8839 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8840 */
8841 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8842 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8843
8844 /**
8845 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
8846 * @dev: The device the frame matched to
8847 * @addr: the transmitter address
8848 * @gfp: context flags
8849 *
8850 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
8851 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
8852 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
8853 * station to avoid event flooding.
8854 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
8855 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
8856 */
8857 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
8858 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
8859
8860 /**
8861 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
8862 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
8863 * @addr: the address of the peer
8864 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
8865 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
8866 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
8867 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
8868 * @gfp: allocation flags
8869 */
8870 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
8871 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
8872 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
8873
8874 /**
8875 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
8876 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8877 * @frame: the frame
8878 * @len: length of the frame
8879 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
8880 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8881 *
8882 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8883 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8884 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8885 */
8886 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
8887 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
8888
8889 /**
8890 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
8891 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
8892 * @frame: the frame
8893 * @len: length of the frame
8894 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
8895 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
8896 *
8897 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
8898 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
8899 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
8900 */
cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,const u8 * frame,size_t len,int freq,int sig_dbm)8901 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8902 const u8 *frame, size_t len,
8903 int freq, int sig_dbm)
8904 {
8905 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
8906 sig_dbm);
8907 }
8908
8909 /**
8910 * struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config - beacon check configuration
8911 * @iftype: the interface type to check for
8912 * @relax: allow IR-relaxation conditions to apply (e.g. another
8913 * interface connected already on the same channel)
8914 * NOTE: If this is set, wiphy mutex must be held.
8915 * @reg_power: &enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power value indicating the
8916 * advertised/used 6 GHz regulatory power setting
8917 */
8918 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config {
8919 enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
8920 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power reg_power;
8921 bool relax;
8922 };
8923
8924 /**
8925 * cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing - check if beaconing is allowed
8926 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8927 * @chandef: the channel definition
8928 * @cfg: additional parameters for the checking
8929 *
8930 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8931 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8932 */
8933 bool cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8934 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8935 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config *cfg);
8936
8937 /**
8938 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
8939 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8940 * @chandef: the channel definition
8941 * @iftype: interface type
8942 *
8943 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8944 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
8945 */
8946 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)8947 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8948 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8949 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
8950 {
8951 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
8952 .iftype = iftype,
8953 };
8954
8955 return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
8956 }
8957
8958 /**
8959 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
8960 * @wiphy: the wiphy
8961 * @chandef: the channel definition
8962 * @iftype: interface type
8963 *
8964 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
8965 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
8966 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
8967 * more permissive conditions.
8968 *
8969 * Context: Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
8970 */
8971 static inline bool
cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy * wiphy,struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef,enum nl80211_iftype iftype)8972 cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8973 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8974 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
8975 {
8976 struct cfg80211_beaconing_check_config config = {
8977 .iftype = iftype,
8978 .relax = true,
8979 };
8980
8981 return cfg80211_reg_check_beaconing(wiphy, chandef, &config);
8982 }
8983
8984 /**
8985 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
8986 * @dev: the device which switched channels
8987 * @chandef: the new channel definition
8988 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
8989 *
8990 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable
8991 * driver context!
8992 */
8993 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
8994 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
8995 unsigned int link_id);
8996
8997 /**
8998 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
8999 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
9000 * @chandef: the future channel definition
9001 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO
9002 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
9003 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
9004 *
9005 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
9006 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
9007 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
9008 */
9009 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9010 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9011 unsigned int link_id, u8 count,
9012 bool quiet);
9013
9014 /**
9015 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
9016 *
9017 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9018 * @band: band pointer to fill
9019 *
9020 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9021 */
9022 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
9023 enum nl80211_band *band);
9024
9025 /**
9026 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef - convert operating class to chandef
9027 *
9028 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
9029 * @chan: the ieee80211_channel to convert
9030 * @chandef: a pointer to the resulting chandef
9031 *
9032 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9033 */
9034 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_chandef(u8 operating_class,
9035 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
9036 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
9037
9038 /**
9039 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
9040 *
9041 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9042 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
9043 *
9044 * Return: %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
9045 */
9046 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
9047 u8 *op_class);
9048
9049 /**
9050 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
9051 *
9052 * @chandef: the chandef to convert
9053 *
9054 * Return: the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
9055 */
9056 static inline u32
ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def * chandef)9057 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
9058 {
9059 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
9060 }
9061
9062 /**
9063 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
9064 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
9065 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
9066 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
9067 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
9068 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
9069 * @gfp: allocation flags
9070 *
9071 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
9072 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
9073 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
9074 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
9075 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
9076 */
9077 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
9078 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
9079 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
9080
9081 /**
9082 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
9083 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
9084 *
9085 * Return: calculated bitrate
9086 */
9087 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
9088
9089 /**
9090 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
9091 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
9092 *
9093 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
9094 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
9095 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
9096 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
9097 * is unbound from the driver.
9098 *
9099 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9100 */
9101 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9102
9103 /**
9104 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
9105 * @dev: the netdev to register
9106 *
9107 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9108 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
9109 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
9110 * instead as well.
9111 *
9112 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9113 *
9114 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9115 */
9116 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
9117
9118 /**
9119 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
9120 * @dev: the netdev to register
9121 *
9122 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
9123 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
9124 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
9125 * usable instead as well.
9126 *
9127 * Context: Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
9128 */
cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device * dev)9129 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
9130 {
9131 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
9132 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
9133 #endif
9134 }
9135
9136 /**
9137 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
9138 * @ies: FT IEs
9139 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
9140 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
9141 * @ric_ies: RIC IE
9142 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
9143 */
9144 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
9145 const u8 *ies;
9146 size_t ies_len;
9147 const u8 *target_ap;
9148 const u8 *ric_ies;
9149 size_t ric_ies_len;
9150 };
9151
9152 /**
9153 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
9154 * @netdev: network device
9155 * @ft_event: IE information
9156 */
9157 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9158 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
9159
9160 /**
9161 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
9162 * @ies: the input IE buffer
9163 * @len: the input length
9164 * @attr: the attribute ID to find
9165 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
9166 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
9167 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
9168 *
9169 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
9170 * copies its contents to the given buffer.
9171 *
9172 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
9173 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
9174 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
9175 */
9176 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
9177 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
9178 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
9179
9180 /**
9181 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
9182 * @ies: the IE buffer
9183 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9184 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9185 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9186 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9187 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9188 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
9189 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
9190 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9191 *
9192 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9193 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9194 * split.
9195 *
9196 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9197 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9198 *
9199 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9200 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9201 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9202 *
9203 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9204 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9205 * used.
9206 */
9207 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9208 const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
9209 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
9210 size_t offset);
9211
9212 /**
9213 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
9214 * @ies: the IE buffer
9215 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
9216 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
9217 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
9218 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
9219 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
9220 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
9221 *
9222 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
9223 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
9224 * split.
9225 *
9226 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
9227 * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
9228 *
9229 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
9230 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
9231 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
9232 *
9233 * Return: The offset where the next part of the buffer starts, which
9234 * may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) of the buffer should be
9235 * used.
9236 */
ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 * ies,size_t ielen,const u8 * ids,int n_ids,size_t offset)9237 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
9238 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
9239 {
9240 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
9241 }
9242
9243 /**
9244 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb
9245 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to
9246 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment
9247 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments
9248 *
9249 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation
9250 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size
9251 * accordingly.
9252 */
9253 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id);
9254
9255 /**
9256 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
9257 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
9258 * @wakeup: the wakeup report
9259 * @gfp: allocation flags
9260 *
9261 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
9262 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
9263 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
9264 * else caused the wakeup.
9265 */
9266 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9267 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
9268 gfp_t gfp);
9269
9270 /**
9271 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
9272 *
9273 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
9274 * @gfp: allocation flags
9275 *
9276 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
9277 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
9278 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
9279 */
9280 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
9281
9282 /**
9283 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
9284 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9285 *
9286 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
9287 */
9288 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9289
9290 /**
9291 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
9292 *
9293 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9294 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9295 *
9296 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
9297 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
9298 * the interface combinations.
9299 *
9300 * Return: 0 if combinations are allowed. Non-zero on error.
9301 */
9302 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9303 struct iface_combination_params *params);
9304
9305 /**
9306 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
9307 *
9308 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9309 * @params: the interface combinations parameter
9310 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
9311 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
9312 *
9313 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
9314 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
9315 * purposes.
9316 *
9317 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9318 */
9319 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9320 struct iface_combination_params *params,
9321 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
9322 void *data),
9323 void *data);
9324
9325 /**
9326 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
9327 *
9328 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9329 * @wdev: wireless device
9330 * @gfp: context flags
9331 *
9332 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
9333 * disconnected.
9334 *
9335 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
9336 */
9337 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9338 gfp_t gfp);
9339
9340 /**
9341 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
9342 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
9343 *
9344 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
9345 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
9346 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
9347 * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
9348 *
9349 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
9350 * the driver while the function is running.
9351 */
9352 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9353
9354 /**
9355 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
9356 *
9357 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9358 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9359 *
9360 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9361 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9362 */
wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9363 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9364 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9365 {
9366 u8 *ft_byte;
9367
9368 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9369 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
9370 }
9371
9372 /**
9373 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
9374 *
9375 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
9376 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
9377 *
9378 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
9379 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
9380 *
9381 * Return: %true if extended feature flag is set, %false otherwise
9382 */
9383 static inline bool
wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy * wiphy,enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)9384 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9385 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
9386 {
9387 u8 ft_byte;
9388
9389 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
9390 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
9391 }
9392
9393 /**
9394 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
9395 * @f: NAN function that should be freed
9396 *
9397 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
9398 */
9399 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
9400
9401 /**
9402 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
9403 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
9404 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
9405 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
9406 * result.
9407 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
9408 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9409 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
9410 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
9411 * @info_len: the length of the &info
9412 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
9413 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
9414 */
9415 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
9416 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
9417 u8 inst_id;
9418 u8 peer_inst_id;
9419 const u8 *addr;
9420 u8 info_len;
9421 const u8 *info;
9422 u64 cookie;
9423 };
9424
9425 /**
9426 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
9427 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9428 * @match: match notification parameters
9429 * @gfp: allocation flags
9430 *
9431 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
9432 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
9433 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
9434 */
9435 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9436 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
9437
9438 /**
9439 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
9440 *
9441 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
9442 * @inst_id: the local instance id
9443 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
9444 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
9445 * @gfp: allocation flags
9446 *
9447 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
9448 */
9449 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9450 u8 inst_id,
9451 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
9452 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
9453
9454 /* ethtool helper */
9455 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
9456
9457 /**
9458 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
9459 * @netdev: network device
9460 * @params: External authentication parameters
9461 * @gfp: allocation flags
9462 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
9463 */
9464 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
9465 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
9466 gfp_t gfp);
9467
9468 /**
9469 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
9470 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9471 * @req: the original measurement request
9472 * @result: the result data
9473 * @gfp: allocation flags
9474 */
9475 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9476 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9477 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
9478 gfp_t gfp);
9479
9480 /**
9481 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
9482 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
9483 * @req: the original measurement request
9484 * @gfp: allocation flags
9485 *
9486 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
9487 * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
9488 */
9489 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
9490 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
9491 gfp_t gfp);
9492
9493 /**
9494 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
9495 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9496 * @iftype: interface type
9497 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
9498 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
9499 *
9500 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
9501 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
9502 * check_swif is '1'.
9503 *
9504 * Return: %true if allowed, %false otherwise
9505 */
9506 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
9507 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
9508
9509
9510 /**
9511 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was
9512 * temporarily rejected with a comeback
9513 * @netdev: network device
9514 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association
9515 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs.
9516 *
9517 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
9518 */
9519 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev,
9520 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout);
9521
9522 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
9523
9524 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
9525
9526 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \
9527 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9528 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9529 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9530 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \
9531 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9532 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \
9533 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9534 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \
9535 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9536 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \
9537 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9538 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \
9539 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9540 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \
9541 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9542 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \
9543 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9544
9545 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9546 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9547 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \
9548 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9549
9550 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \
9551 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
9552
9553 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9554 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
9555
9556 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
9557 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg
9558 #else
9559 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \
9560 ({ \
9561 if (0) \
9562 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \
9563 0; \
9564 })
9565 #endif
9566
9567 /*
9568 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
9569 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
9570 * file/line information and a backtrace.
9571 */
9572 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \
9573 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
9574
9575 /**
9576 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
9577 * @netdev: network device
9578 * @owe_info: peer's owe info
9579 * @gfp: allocation flags
9580 */
9581 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
9582 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
9583 gfp_t gfp);
9584
9585 /**
9586 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
9587 * @wiphy: the wiphy
9588 */
9589 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
9590
9591 /**
9592 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event
9593 * @dev: network device
9594 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify
9595 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9596 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9597 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9598 *
9599 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9600 */
9601 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9602 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count,
9603 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
9604
9605 /**
9606 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision
9607 * @dev: network device
9608 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of
9609 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9610 *
9611 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9612 */
cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device * dev,u64 color_bitmap,u8 link_id)9613 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9614 u64 color_bitmap,
9615 u8 link_id)
9616 {
9617 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION,
9618 0, color_bitmap, link_id);
9619 }
9620
9621 /**
9622 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start
9623 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9624 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens
9625 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9626 *
9627 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started.
9628 *
9629 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9630 */
cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 count,u8 link_id)9631 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9632 u8 count, u8 link_id)
9633 {
9634 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED,
9635 count, 0, link_id);
9636 }
9637
9638 /**
9639 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort
9640 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched
9641 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9642 *
9643 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted.
9644 *
9645 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9646 */
cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9647 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9648 u8 link_id)
9649 {
9650 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED,
9651 0, 0, link_id);
9652 }
9653
9654 /**
9655 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion
9656 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched
9657 * @link_id: valid link_id in case of MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
9658 *
9659 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed.
9660 *
9661 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
9662 */
cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device * dev,u8 link_id)9663 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev,
9664 u8 link_id)
9665 {
9666 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev,
9667 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED,
9668 0, 0, link_id);
9669 }
9670
9671 /**
9672 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links.
9673 * @dev: network device.
9674 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs.
9675 *
9676 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to
9677 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link
9678 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this
9679 * case disconnect instead.
9680 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held.
9681 */
9682 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask);
9683
9684 /**
9685 * cfg80211_schedule_channels_check - schedule regulatory check if needed
9686 * @wdev: the wireless device to check
9687 *
9688 * In case the device supports NO_IR or DFS relaxations, schedule regulatory
9689 * channels check, as previous concurrent operation conditions may not
9690 * hold anymore.
9691 */
9692 void cfg80211_schedule_channels_check(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
9693
9694 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS
9695 /**
9696 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs
9697 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9698 * @file: the file being read
9699 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from
9700 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9701 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to
9702 * @count: read count
9703 * @ppos: read position
9704 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9705 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler
9706 *
9707 * Return: the number of characters read, or a negative errno
9708 */
9709 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9710 char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9711 char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9712 loff_t *ppos,
9713 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9714 struct file *file,
9715 char *buf,
9716 size_t bufsize,
9717 void *data),
9718 void *data);
9719
9720 /**
9721 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs
9722 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use
9723 * @file: the file being written to
9724 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to
9725 * @bufsize: size of the buffer
9726 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from
9727 * @count: read count
9728 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock)
9729 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler
9730 *
9731 * Return: the number of characters written, or a negative errno
9732 */
9733 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file,
9734 char *buf, size_t bufsize,
9735 const char __user *userbuf, size_t count,
9736 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
9737 struct file *file,
9738 char *buf,
9739 size_t count,
9740 void *data),
9741 void *data);
9742 #endif
9743
9744 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
9745